]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - gdb/breakpoint.c
Replace most calls to help_list and cmd_show_list
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "ui-out.h"
48 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
49 #include "block.h"
50 #include "solib.h"
51 #include "solist.h"
52 #include "observable.h"
53 #include "memattr.h"
54 #include "ada-lang.h"
55 #include "top.h"
56 #include "valprint.h"
57 #include "jit.h"
58 #include "parser-defs.h"
59 #include "gdb_regex.h"
60 #include "probe.h"
61 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
62 #include "stack.h"
63 #include "ax-gdb.h"
64 #include "dummy-frame.h"
65 #include "interps.h"
66 #include "gdbsupport/format.h"
67 #include "thread-fsm.h"
68 #include "tid-parse.h"
69 #include "cli/cli-style.h"
70
71 /* readline include files */
72 #include "readline/tilde.h"
73
74 /* readline defines this. */
75 #undef savestring
76
77 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
78 #include "extension.h"
79 #include <algorithm>
80 #include "progspace-and-thread.h"
81 #include "gdbsupport/array-view.h"
82 #include "gdbsupport/gdb_optional.h"
83
84 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
85
86 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
87 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>);
88
89 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
90
91 static void
92 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
93 struct linespec_result *canonical,
94 enum bptype type_wanted);
95
96 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
97 struct linespec_result *,
98 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
99 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
100 enum bptype,
101 enum bpdisp, int, int,
102 int,
103 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
104 int, int, int, unsigned);
105
106 static std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_default
107 (struct breakpoint *b, const struct event_location *location,
108 struct program_space *search_pspace);
109
110 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint
111 (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals);
112
113 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
114
115 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
116 enum bptype,
117 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
118 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
119 const struct symtab_and_line *);
120
121 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
122 static. */
123 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
124 struct symtab_and_line,
125 enum bptype,
126 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
127
128 static struct breakpoint *
129 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
130 enum bptype type,
131 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
132 int loc_enabled);
133
134 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
135
136 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
137 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
138 enum bptype bptype);
139
140 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
141 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
142 struct obj_section *, int);
143
144 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
145 struct bp_location *loc2);
146
147 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
148 const struct address_space *aspace,
149 CORE_ADDR addr);
150
151 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
152 const address_space *,
153 CORE_ADDR, int);
154
155 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
156 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
157
158 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
159
160 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
161
162 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
163
164 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
165 enum bptype type,
166 int *other_type_used);
167
168 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
169 int count);
170
171 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
172 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
173 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
174
175 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
176
177 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
178 insert locations now. */
179 enum ugll_insert_mode
180 {
181 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
182 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
183 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
184 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
185 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
186 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
187 returns true on them.
188
189 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
190 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
191 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
192 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
193 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
194 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
195 the inferior. */
196 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
197
198 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
199 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
200 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
201
202 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
203 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
204 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
205 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
206 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
207 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
208 as no thread is running yet. */
209 UGLL_INSERT
210 };
211
212 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
213
214 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
215
216 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
217
218 static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int);
219
220 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
221
222 static bool is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
223
224 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
225
226 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
227 otherwise. */
228
229 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
230
231 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
232 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
233 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
234 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
235
236 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
237 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
238
239 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
240 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
241
242 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
243 breakpoints. */
244 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
245
246 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
247 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
248
249 /* Tracepoints set on probes. */
250 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
251
252 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
253 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
254
255 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
256 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
257 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
258 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
259 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
260 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
261
262 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
263 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
264 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
265 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
266 dprintf_style_gdb,
267 dprintf_style_call,
268 dprintf_style_agent,
269 NULL
270 };
271 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
272
273 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
274 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
275 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
276 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
277
278 static char *dprintf_function;
279
280 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
281 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
282 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
283 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
284 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
285 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
286 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
287
288 static char *dprintf_channel;
289
290 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
291 has disconnected. */
292 static bool disconnected_dprintf = true;
293
294 struct command_line *
295 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
296 {
297 return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
298 }
299
300 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
301 current breakpoint. */
302
303 static bool breakpoint_proceeded;
304
305 const char *
306 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
307 {
308 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
309 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
310 a breakpoint. */
311 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
312
313 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
314 }
315
316 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
317 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
318 if such is available. */
319 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
320
321 static void
322 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
323 struct cmd_list_element *c,
324 const char *value)
325 {
326 fprintf_filtered (file,
327 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
328 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
329 value);
330 }
331
332 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
333 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
334 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
335 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
336 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
337 static void
338 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
339 struct cmd_list_element *c,
340 const char *value)
341 {
342 fprintf_filtered (file,
343 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
344 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
345 value);
346 }
347
348 /* If true, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
349 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
350 If false, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
351 use hardware breakpoints. */
352 static bool automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
353 static void
354 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
355 struct cmd_list_element *c,
356 const char *value)
357 {
358 fprintf_filtered (file,
359 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
360 value);
361 }
362
363 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
364 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
365 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
366 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
367 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
368 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
369 processing user input. */
370 static bool always_inserted_mode = false;
371
372 static void
373 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
374 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
375 {
376 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
377 value);
378 }
379
380 /* See breakpoint.h. */
381
382 int
383 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
384 {
385 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
386 {
387 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
388 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
389 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
390 return 1;
391 }
392 else
393 {
394 if (always_inserted_mode)
395 {
396 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
397 are stopped. */
398 return 1;
399 }
400
401 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
402 if (inf->has_execution ()
403 && threads_are_executing (inf->process_target ()))
404 return 1;
405
406 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
407 stopped, we still have events to process. */
408 for (thread_info *tp : all_non_exited_threads ())
409 if (tp->resumed
410 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
411 return 1;
412 }
413 return 0;
414 }
415
416 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
417
418 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
419 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
420 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
421 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
422 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
423 condition_evaluation_auto,
424 condition_evaluation_host,
425 condition_evaluation_target,
426 NULL
427 };
428
429 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
430 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
431
432 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
433 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
434 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
435
436 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
437 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
438 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
439 evaluation mode. */
440
441 static const char *
442 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
443 {
444 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
445 {
446 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
447 return condition_evaluation_target;
448 else
449 return condition_evaluation_host;
450 }
451 else
452 return mode;
453 }
454
455 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
456
457 static const char *
458 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
459 {
460 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
461 }
462
463 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
464 otherwise. */
465
466 static int
467 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
468 {
469 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
470
471 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
472 }
473
474 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
475 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
476
477 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
478 static int overlay_events_enabled;
479
480 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
481 bool target_exact_watchpoints = false;
482
483 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
484 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
485 current breakpoint. */
486
487 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
488
489 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
490 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
491 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
492 B = TMP)
493
494 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
495 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
496 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
497
498 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
499 for (BP_TMP = bp_locations; \
500 BP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count && (B = *BP_TMP);\
501 BP_TMP++)
502
503 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
504 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
505 to where the loop should start from.
506 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
507 appropriate location to start with. */
508
509 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
510 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
511 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
512 BP_LOCP_START \
513 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count \
514 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
515 BP_LOCP_TMP++)
516
517 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
518
519 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
520 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
521 if (is_tracepoint (B))
522
523 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
524
525 static struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
526
527 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_is_less_than - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
528
529 static struct bp_location **bp_locations;
530
531 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATIONS. */
532
533 static unsigned bp_locations_count;
534
535 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
536 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid
537 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
538 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for
539 an address you need to read. */
540
541 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max;
542
543 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
544 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
545 BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
546 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to
547 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
548
549 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max;
550
551 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
552 from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be
553 reported by a target. */
554 static std::vector<bp_location *> moribund_locations;
555
556 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
557
558 static int breakpoint_count;
559
560 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
561 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
562 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
563 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
564 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
565
566 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
567
568 static int tracepoint_count;
569
570 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
571 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
572 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
573
574 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
575
576 struct breakpoint *
577 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
578 void *user_data)
579 {
580 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
581
582 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
583 {
584 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
585 break;
586 }
587
588 return b;
589 }
590
591 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
592 static int
593 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
594 {
595 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
596 }
597
598 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
599
600 static void
601 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
602 {
603 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
604 breakpoint_count = num;
605 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
606 }
607
608 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
609 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
610 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
611
612 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
613 breakpoint made. */
614
615 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
616 {
617 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
618 }
619
620 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
621 breakpoint made. */
622
623 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
624 {
625 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
626 }
627
628 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
629
630 void
631 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
632 {
633 struct breakpoint *b;
634
635 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
636 b->hit_count = 0;
637 }
638
639 \f
640 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
641 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
642
643 struct breakpoint *
644 get_breakpoint (int num)
645 {
646 struct breakpoint *b;
647
648 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
649 if (b->number == num)
650 return b;
651
652 return NULL;
653 }
654
655 \f
656
657 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
658 evaluating conditions on its side. */
659
660 static void
661 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
662 {
663 struct bp_location *loc;
664
665 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
666 evaluating conditions and if the user has
667 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
668 side. */
669 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
670 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
671 return;
672
673 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
674 return;
675
676 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
677 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
678 }
679
680 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
681 evaluating conditions on its side. */
682
683 static void
684 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
685 {
686 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
687 evaluating conditions and if the user has
688 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
689 side. */
690 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
691 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
692
693 return;
694
695 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
696 return;
697
698 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
699 }
700
701 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
702 condition_evaluation_mode. */
703
704 static void
705 set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty,
706 struct cmd_list_element *c)
707 {
708 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
709
710 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
711 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
712 {
713 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
714 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
715 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
716 return;
717 }
718
719 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
720 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
721
722 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
723 settings was "auto". */
724 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
725
726 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
727 if (new_mode != old_mode)
728 {
729 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
730 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
731 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
732
733 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
734 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
735 */
736
737 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
738 {
739 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
740 target. */
741 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
742 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
743 }
744 else
745 {
746 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
747 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
748 target knows about. */
749 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
750 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
751 loc->needs_update = 1;
752 }
753
754 /* Do the update. */
755 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
756 }
757
758 return;
759 }
760
761 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
762 what "auto" is translating to. */
763
764 static void
765 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
766 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
767 {
768 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
769 fprintf_filtered (file,
770 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
771 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
772 value,
773 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
774 else
775 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
776 value);
777 }
778
779 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
780 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
781 the more general bp_location_is_less_than function. */
782
783 static int
784 bp_locations_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
785 {
786 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
787 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
788
789 if (a->address == b->address)
790 return 0;
791 else
792 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
793 }
794
795 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
796 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
797 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
798 return NULL. */
799
800 static struct bp_location **
801 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
802 {
803 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
804 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
805 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
806
807 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
808 dummy_loc.address = address;
809
810 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
811 locp_found = ((struct bp_location **)
812 bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_locations, bp_locations_count,
813 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
814 bp_locations_compare_addrs));
815
816 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
817 if (locp_found == NULL)
818 return NULL;
819
820 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
821 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
822 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_locations
823 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
824 locp_found--;
825
826 return locp_found;
827 }
828
829 void
830 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
831 int from_tty)
832 {
833 xfree (b->cond_string);
834 b->cond_string = NULL;
835
836 if (is_watchpoint (b))
837 {
838 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
839
840 w->cond_exp.reset ();
841 }
842 else
843 {
844 struct bp_location *loc;
845
846 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
847 {
848 loc->cond.reset ();
849
850 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
851 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
852 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
853 }
854 }
855
856 if (*exp == 0)
857 {
858 if (from_tty)
859 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
860 }
861 else
862 {
863 const char *arg = exp;
864
865 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
866 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
867 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
868 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
869
870 if (is_watchpoint (b))
871 {
872 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
873
874 innermost_block_tracker tracker;
875 arg = exp;
876 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker);
877 if (*arg)
878 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
879 w->cond_exp_valid_block = tracker.block ();
880 }
881 else
882 {
883 struct bp_location *loc;
884
885 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
886 {
887 arg = exp;
888 loc->cond =
889 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
890 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
891 if (*arg)
892 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
893 }
894 }
895 }
896 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
897
898 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
899 }
900
901 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
902
903 static void
904 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
905 completion_tracker &tracker,
906 const char *text, const char *word)
907 {
908 const char *space;
909
910 text = skip_spaces (text);
911 space = skip_to_space (text);
912 if (*space == '\0')
913 {
914 int len;
915 struct breakpoint *b;
916
917 if (text[0] == '$')
918 {
919 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
920 if (!isdigit (text[1]))
921 complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]);
922 return;
923 }
924
925 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
926 len = strlen (text);
927
928 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
929 {
930 char number[50];
931
932 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
933
934 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
935 tracker.add_completion (make_unique_xstrdup (number));
936 }
937
938 return;
939 }
940
941 /* We're completing the expression part. */
942 text = skip_spaces (space);
943 expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word);
944 }
945
946 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
947
948 static void
949 condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
950 {
951 struct breakpoint *b;
952 const char *p;
953 int bnum;
954
955 if (arg == 0)
956 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
957
958 p = arg;
959 bnum = get_number (&p);
960 if (bnum == 0)
961 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
962
963 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
964 if (b->number == bnum)
965 {
966 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
967 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
968 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
969 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
970 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
971
972 if (extlang != NULL)
973 {
974 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
975 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
976 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
977 }
978 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
979
980 if (is_breakpoint (b))
981 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
982
983 return;
984 }
985
986 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
987 }
988
989 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
990 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
991 Throw if any such commands is found. */
992
993 static void
994 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
995 {
996 struct command_line *c;
997
998 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
999 {
1000 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1001 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1002 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1003
1004 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_0.get ());
1005 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_1.get ());
1006
1007 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1008 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1009 command directly. */
1010 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1011 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1012
1013 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1014 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1015 }
1016 }
1017
1018 struct longjmp_breakpoint : public breakpoint
1019 {
1020 ~longjmp_breakpoint () override;
1021 };
1022
1023 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1024
1025 static bool
1026 is_tracepoint_type (bptype type)
1027 {
1028 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1029 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1030 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1031 }
1032
1033 static bool
1034 is_longjmp_type (bptype type)
1035 {
1036 return type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception;
1037 }
1038
1039 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1040
1041 bool
1042 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1043 {
1044 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1045 }
1046
1047 /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given
1048 TYPE. */
1049
1050 static std::unique_ptr<breakpoint>
1051 new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype type)
1052 {
1053 breakpoint *b;
1054
1055 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
1056 b = new tracepoint ();
1057 else if (is_longjmp_type (type))
1058 b = new longjmp_breakpoint ();
1059 else
1060 b = new breakpoint ();
1061
1062 return std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> (b);
1063 }
1064
1065 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1066 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1067 found. */
1068
1069 static void
1070 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1071 struct command_line *commands)
1072 {
1073 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1074 {
1075 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1076 struct command_line *c;
1077 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1078
1079 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1080 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1081 ones might not. */
1082 t->step_count = 0;
1083
1084 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1085 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1086 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1087 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1088 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1089 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1090 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1091 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1092 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1093 tracepoint's context. */
1094 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1095 {
1096 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1097 {
1098 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1099 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1100 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1101 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1102 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1103 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1104
1105 if (while_stepping)
1106 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1107 "can be used only once"));
1108 else
1109 while_stepping = c;
1110 }
1111
1112 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1113 }
1114 if (while_stepping)
1115 {
1116 struct command_line *c2;
1117
1118 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_list_1 == nullptr);
1119 c2 = while_stepping->body_list_0.get ();
1120 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1121 {
1122 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1123 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1124 }
1125 }
1126 }
1127 else
1128 {
1129 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1130 }
1131 }
1132
1133 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1134 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1135
1136 std::vector<breakpoint *>
1137 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1138 {
1139 struct breakpoint *b;
1140 std::vector<breakpoint *> found;
1141 struct bp_location *loc;
1142
1143 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1144 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1145 {
1146 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1147 if (loc->address == addr)
1148 found.push_back (b);
1149 }
1150
1151 return found;
1152 }
1153
1154 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1155 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1156
1157 void
1158 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1159 counted_command_line &&commands)
1160 {
1161 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ());
1162
1163 b->commands = std::move (commands);
1164 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1165 }
1166
1167 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1168 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1169 commands. */
1170
1171 void
1172 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1173 {
1174 int old_silent = b->silent;
1175
1176 b->silent = silent;
1177 if (old_silent != silent)
1178 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1179 }
1180
1181 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1182 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1183
1184 void
1185 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1186 {
1187 int old_thread = b->thread;
1188
1189 b->thread = thread;
1190 if (old_thread != thread)
1191 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1192 }
1193
1194 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1195 breakpoint work for any task. */
1196
1197 void
1198 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1199 {
1200 int old_task = b->task;
1201
1202 b->task = task;
1203 if (old_task != task)
1204 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1205 }
1206
1207 static void
1208 commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
1209 struct command_line *control)
1210 {
1211 counted_command_line cmd;
1212 /* cmd_read will be true once we have read cmd. Note that cmd might still be
1213 NULL after the call to read_command_lines if the user provides an empty
1214 list of command by just typing "end". */
1215 bool cmd_read = false;
1216
1217 std::string new_arg;
1218
1219 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1220 {
1221 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1222 new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1223 breakpoint_count);
1224 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1225 new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1226 arg = new_arg.c_str ();
1227 }
1228
1229 map_breakpoint_numbers
1230 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
1231 {
1232 if (!cmd_read)
1233 {
1234 gdb_assert (cmd == NULL);
1235 if (control != NULL)
1236 cmd = control->body_list_0;
1237 else
1238 {
1239 std::string str
1240 = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1241 "%s, one per line."),
1242 arg);
1243
1244 auto do_validate = [=] (const char *line)
1245 {
1246 validate_actionline (line, b);
1247 };
1248 gdb::function_view<void (const char *)> validator;
1249 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1250 validator = do_validate;
1251
1252 cmd = read_command_lines (str.c_str (), from_tty, 1, validator);
1253 }
1254 cmd_read = true;
1255 }
1256
1257 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1258 do anything. */
1259 if (b->commands != cmd)
1260 {
1261 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ());
1262 b->commands = cmd;
1263 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1264 }
1265 });
1266 }
1267
1268 static void
1269 commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
1270 {
1271 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1272 }
1273
1274 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1275 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1276
1277 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1278 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1279 enum command_control_type
1280 commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1281 {
1282 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1283 return simple_control;
1284 }
1285
1286 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1287
1288 static int
1289 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1290 {
1291 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1292 return 0;
1293 if (!bl->inserted)
1294 return 0;
1295 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1296 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1297 return 0;
1298 return 1;
1299 }
1300
1301 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1302 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1303 contents.
1304
1305 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1306 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1307 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1308
1309 static void
1310 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1311 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1312 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1313 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1314 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1315 {
1316 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1317 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1318 int bp_size = 0;
1319 int bptoffset = 0;
1320
1321 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1322 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1323 {
1324 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1325 return;
1326 }
1327
1328 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1329 we need to copy. */
1330 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1331 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1332
1333 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1334 {
1335 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1336 reading. */
1337 return;
1338 }
1339
1340 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1341 {
1342 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1343 reading. */
1344 return;
1345 }
1346
1347 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1348 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1349 {
1350 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1351 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1352 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1353 bp_addr = memaddr;
1354 }
1355
1356 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1357 {
1358 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1359 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1360 }
1361
1362 if (readbuf != NULL)
1363 {
1364 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1365 shadow_contents buffer. */
1366 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1367 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1368 + target_info->shadow_len));
1369
1370 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1371 shadow. */
1372 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1373 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1374 }
1375 else
1376 {
1377 const unsigned char *bp;
1378 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1379 int placed_size;
1380
1381 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1382 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1383 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1384
1385 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1386 address. */
1387 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1388
1389 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1390 breakpoint's INSN. */
1391 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1392 }
1393 }
1394
1395 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1396 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1397
1398 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1399 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1400 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1401
1402 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1403 bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1404 up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1405 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1406 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1407 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1408 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1409 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
1410 and:
1411 bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1412
1413 void
1414 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1415 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1416 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1417 {
1418 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1419 search. */
1420 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1421
1422 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1423 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1424 report higher one. */
1425
1426 bc_l = 0;
1427 bc_r = bp_locations_count;
1428 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1429 {
1430 struct bp_location *bl;
1431
1432 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1433 bl = bp_locations[bc];
1434
1435 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1436 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1437 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1438 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1439
1440 Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1441 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1442 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1443
1444 if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1445 >= bl->address)
1446 && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1447 <= memaddr))
1448 bc_l = bc;
1449 else
1450 bc_r = bc;
1451 }
1452
1453 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1454 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1455 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1456 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1457 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1458 B:
1459
1460 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1461
1462 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1463 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1464 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1465 and L2. */
1466 while (bc_l > 0
1467 && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address)
1468 bc_l--;
1469
1470 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1471
1472 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations_count; bc++)
1473 {
1474 struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc];
1475
1476 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1477 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1478 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1479 bl->owner->number);
1480
1481 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1482 content. */
1483
1484 if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1485 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1486 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max))
1487 break;
1488
1489 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1490 continue;
1491
1492 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1493 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1494 }
1495 }
1496
1497 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1498
1499 bool
1500 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1501 {
1502 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1503 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1504 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1505 }
1506
1507 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1508
1509 static bool
1510 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1511 {
1512 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1513 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1514 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1515 }
1516
1517 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1518
1519 bool
1520 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1521 {
1522 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1523 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1524 }
1525
1526 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1527 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1528 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1529 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1530 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1531 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1532 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1533 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1534
1535 static int
1536 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1537 {
1538 return (b->pspace == current_program_space
1539 && (b->watchpoint_thread == null_ptid
1540 || (inferior_ptid == b->watchpoint_thread
1541 && !inferior_thread ()->executing)));
1542 }
1543
1544 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1545 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1546
1547 static void
1548 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1549 {
1550 if (w->related_breakpoint != w)
1551 {
1552 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1553 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w);
1554 w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1555 w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint;
1556 w->related_breakpoint = w;
1557 }
1558 w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1559 }
1560
1561 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1562 watchpoint W. */
1563
1564 static struct value *
1565 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1566 {
1567 struct value *bit_val;
1568
1569 if (val == NULL)
1570 return NULL;
1571
1572 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1573
1574 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1575 w->val_bitpos,
1576 w->val_bitsize,
1577 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1578 value_offset (val),
1579 val);
1580
1581 return bit_val;
1582 }
1583
1584 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1585 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1586 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1587 to be able to report stops. */
1588
1589 static void
1590 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
1591 struct program_space *pspace)
1592 {
1593 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
1594
1595 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1596 b->loc->pspace = pspace;
1597 b->loc->address = -1;
1598 b->loc->length = -1;
1599 }
1600
1601 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1602 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1603
1604 static bool
1605 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
1606 {
1607 return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
1608 && b->loc != NULL
1609 && b->loc->next == NULL
1610 && b->loc->address == -1
1611 && b->loc->length == -1);
1612 }
1613
1614 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1615 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1616 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1617 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1618 in b->loc->cond.
1619 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1620
1621 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1622 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1623 it.
1624
1625 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1626 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1627 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1628 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1629 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1630 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1631 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1632 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1633
1634 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1635 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1636 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1637 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1638 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1639 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1640 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1641 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1642 not changed.
1643
1644 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1645 hardware watchpoints:
1646
1647 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1648 called several times when GDB stops.
1649
1650 [linux]
1651 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1652 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1653 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1654 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1655 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1656 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1657 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1658 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1659 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1660 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1661 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1662
1663 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1664 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1665
1666 static void
1667 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1668 {
1669 int within_current_scope;
1670 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1671 int frame_saved;
1672
1673 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1674 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1675 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1676 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1677 return;
1678
1679 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1680 return;
1681
1682 frame_saved = 0;
1683
1684 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1685 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1686 within_current_scope = 1;
1687 else
1688 {
1689 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1690 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1691 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1692
1693 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1694 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1695 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1696 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1697 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1698 return;
1699
1700 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1701 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1702 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1703 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1704 selected frame. */
1705 frame_saved = 1;
1706 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1707
1708 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1709 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1710 if (within_current_scope)
1711 select_frame (fi);
1712 }
1713
1714 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1715 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1716 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1717 b->loc = NULL;
1718
1719 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1720 {
1721 const char *s;
1722
1723 b->exp.reset ();
1724 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1725 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1726 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1727 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1728 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1729 be completely different objects. */
1730 b->val = NULL;
1731 b->val_valid = false;
1732
1733 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1734 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1735 locations (re)created below. */
1736 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1737 {
1738 b->cond_exp.reset ();
1739
1740 s = b->cond_string;
1741 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1742 }
1743 }
1744
1745 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1746 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1747 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1748 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1749 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1750 if (!target_has_execution)
1751 {
1752 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1753 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1754 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1755 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1756 {
1757 if (b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1758 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1759 else
1760 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1761 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1762 }
1763 }
1764 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1765 {
1766 int pc = 0;
1767 std::vector<value_ref_ptr> val_chain;
1768 struct value *v, *result;
1769 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1770
1771 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1772
1773 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1774 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1775 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1776 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1777 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1778 watchpoints. */
1779 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b))
1780 {
1781 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1782 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1783 b->val = release_value (v);
1784 b->val_valid = true;
1785 }
1786
1787 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1788
1789 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1790 gdb_assert (!val_chain.empty ());
1791 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : val_chain)
1792 {
1793 v = iter.get ();
1794
1795 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1796 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1797 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1798 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1799 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1800 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1801 && (v == val_chain[0] || ! value_lazy (v)))
1802 {
1803 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1804
1805 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1806 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1807 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1808 if (v == result
1809 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1810 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1811 {
1812 CORE_ADDR addr;
1813 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1814 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1815 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1816
1817 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1818 {
1819 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1820 sub-expression. */
1821 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1822 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1823 }
1824 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1825 {
1826 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1827 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1828 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1829 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1830 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
1831 }
1832
1833 addr = value_address (v);
1834 if (bitsize != 0)
1835 {
1836 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
1837 addr += bitpos / 8;
1838 }
1839
1840 type = hw_write;
1841 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1842 type = hw_read;
1843 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1844 type = hw_access;
1845
1846 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1847 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1848 ;
1849 *tmp = loc;
1850 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1851
1852 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1853 loc->address = address_significant (loc->gdbarch, addr);
1854
1855 if (bitsize != 0)
1856 {
1857 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
1858 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
1859 }
1860 else
1861 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1862
1863 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1864 }
1865 }
1866 }
1867
1868 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1869 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1870 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1871 is started. */
1872 if (reparse)
1873 {
1874 int reg_cnt;
1875 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
1876 struct bp_location *bl;
1877
1878 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1879
1880 if (reg_cnt)
1881 {
1882 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
1883 enum bptype type;
1884
1885 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
1886 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
1887 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
1888
1889 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
1890 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
1891 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
1892 this watchpoint in as well. */
1893
1894 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
1895 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
1896 hardware watchpoint type. */
1897 type = b->type;
1898 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
1899 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1900
1901 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
1902 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
1903 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
1904 through watch_command), so always account for it
1905 manually. */
1906
1907 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
1908 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used);
1909
1910 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
1911 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
1912
1913 target_resources_ok
1914 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
1915 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1916 {
1917 int sw_mode = b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b);
1918
1919 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
1920 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
1921 "hardware watchpoint."));
1922 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
1923 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
1924 "resources for this watchpoint."));
1925
1926 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
1927 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1928 }
1929 else
1930 {
1931 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
1932 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
1933 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
1934 nop. */
1935 b->type = type;
1936 }
1937 }
1938 else if (!b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1939 {
1940 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1941 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1942 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1943 else
1944 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
1945 "read/access watchpoint."));
1946 }
1947 else
1948 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1949
1950 loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
1951 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
1952 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
1953 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
1954 }
1955
1956 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1957 above left it without any location set up. But,
1958 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1959 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1960 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
1961 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (b, frame_pspace);
1962 }
1963 else if (!within_current_scope)
1964 {
1965 printf_filtered (_("\
1966 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
1967 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1968 b->number);
1969 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
1970 }
1971
1972 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1973 if (frame_saved)
1974 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1975 }
1976
1977
1978 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1979 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
1980 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
1981 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
1982 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
1983 static int
1984 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
1985 {
1986 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
1987 return 0;
1988
1989 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1990 return 0;
1991
1992 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
1993 return 0;
1994
1995 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
1996 return 0;
1997
1998 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1999 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2000 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2001 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2002 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2003 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2004 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2005 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2006 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2007 return 0;
2008
2009 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2010 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2011 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2012 a breakpoint. */
2013 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2014 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2015 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2016 bl->address)
2017 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2018 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2019 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2020 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2021 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2022 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2023 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2024 && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
2025 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
2026 {
2027 if (debug_infrun)
2028 {
2029 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2030 "infrun: skipping breakpoint: "
2031 "stepping past insn at: %s\n",
2032 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2033 }
2034 return 0;
2035 }
2036
2037 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2038 instruction that triggered one. */
2039 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2040 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2041 {
2042 if (debug_infrun)
2043 {
2044 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2045 "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2046 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2047 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2048 bl->length);
2049 }
2050 return 0;
2051 }
2052
2053 return 1;
2054 }
2055
2056 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2057 that the location is not duplicated. */
2058
2059 static int
2060 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2061 {
2062 int result;
2063 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2064
2065 bl->duplicate = 0;
2066 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2067 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2068 return result;
2069 }
2070
2071 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2072 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2073 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2074 any error during parsing. */
2075
2076 static agent_expr_up
2077 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2078 {
2079 if (cond == NULL)
2080 return NULL;
2081
2082 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2083
2084 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2085 that may show up. */
2086 try
2087 {
2088 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2089 }
2090
2091 catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
2092 {
2093 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2094 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2095 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2096 }
2097
2098 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2099 return aexpr;
2100 }
2101
2102 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2103 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2104 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2105 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2106 one of them is true. */
2107
2108 static void
2109 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2110 {
2111 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2112 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2113 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2114 struct bp_location *loc;
2115
2116 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2117 bl->target_info.conditions.clear ();
2118
2119 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2120 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2121 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2122 side. */
2123 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2124 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2125 return;
2126
2127 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2128 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2129 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2130 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2131 response back to GDB. */
2132 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2133 {
2134 loc = (*loc2p);
2135 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2136 {
2137 if (modified)
2138 {
2139 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2140 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2141 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2142 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2143 loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2144 loc->cond.get ());
2145 }
2146
2147 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2148 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2149 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2150 {
2151 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2152 break;
2153 }
2154 }
2155 }
2156
2157 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2158 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2159 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2160
2161 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2162 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2163 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2164 {
2165 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2166 {
2167 loc = (*loc2p);
2168 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2169 {
2170 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2171 located. */
2172 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2173 return;
2174
2175 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
2176 }
2177 }
2178 }
2179
2180 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2181 for this location's address. */
2182 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2183 {
2184 loc = (*loc2p);
2185 if (loc->cond
2186 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2187 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2188 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2189 && loc->enabled)
2190 {
2191 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
2192 to send the conditions to the target. */
2193 bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ());
2194 }
2195 }
2196
2197 return;
2198 }
2199
2200 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2201 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2202 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2203
2204 static agent_expr_up
2205 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2206 {
2207 const char *cmdrest;
2208 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2209 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2210
2211 if (cmd == NULL)
2212 return NULL;
2213
2214 cmdrest = cmd;
2215
2216 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2217 ++cmdrest;
2218 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2219
2220 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2221 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2222
2223 format_start = cmdrest;
2224
2225 format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest);
2226
2227 format_end = cmdrest;
2228
2229 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2230 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2231
2232 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2233
2234 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2235 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2236
2237 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2238 cmdrest++;
2239 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2240
2241 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2242
2243 std::vector<struct expression *> argvec;
2244 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2245 {
2246 const char *cmd1;
2247
2248 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2249 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2250 argvec.push_back (expr.release ());
2251 cmdrest = cmd1;
2252 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2253 ++cmdrest;
2254 }
2255
2256 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2257
2258 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2259 that may show up. */
2260 try
2261 {
2262 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2263 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2264 argvec.size (), argvec.data ());
2265 }
2266 catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
2267 {
2268 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2269 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2270 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2271 }
2272
2273 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2274 return aexpr;
2275 }
2276
2277 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2278 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2279 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2280
2281 static void
2282 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2283 {
2284 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2285 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2286 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2287 struct bp_location *loc;
2288
2289 /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
2290 bl->target_info.tcommands.clear ();
2291
2292 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2293 return;
2294
2295 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2296 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2297 return;
2298
2299 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2300 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2301 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2302 control. */
2303 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2304 {
2305 loc = (*loc2p);
2306 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2307 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2308 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2309 return;
2310 }
2311
2312 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2313 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2314 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2315 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2316 response back to GDB. */
2317 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2318 {
2319 loc = (*loc2p);
2320 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2321 {
2322 if (modified)
2323 {
2324 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2325 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2326 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2327 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2328 loc->cmd_bytecode
2329 = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2330 loc->owner->extra_string);
2331 }
2332
2333 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2334 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2335 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2336 {
2337 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2338 break;
2339 }
2340 }
2341 }
2342
2343 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2344 and so clean up. */
2345 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2346 {
2347 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2348 {
2349 loc = (*loc2p);
2350 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2351 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2352 {
2353 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2354 located. */
2355 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2356 return;
2357
2358 loc->cmd_bytecode.reset ();
2359 }
2360 }
2361 }
2362
2363 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2364 for this location's address. */
2365 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2366 {
2367 loc = (*loc2p);
2368 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2369 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2370 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2371 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2372 && loc->enabled)
2373 {
2374 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2375 to send the commands to the target. */
2376 bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ());
2377 }
2378 }
2379
2380 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2381 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2382 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2383 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2384 }
2385
2386 /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
2387 of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
2388 Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
2389 registers state. */
2390
2391 static int
2392 breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr)
2393 {
2394 if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step)
2395 {
2396 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread);
2397 struct regcache *regcache;
2398
2399 regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr);
2400
2401 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch,
2402 regcache, addr);
2403 }
2404 else
2405 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr);
2406 }
2407
2408 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2409 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2410 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2411 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2412 -1 for failure.
2413
2414 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2415 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2416 static int
2417 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2418 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2419 int *disabled_breaks,
2420 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2421 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2422 {
2423 gdb_exception bp_excpt;
2424
2425 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2426 return 0;
2427
2428 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2429 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2430 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2431 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2432 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2433 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2434 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2435 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2436 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2437 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2438 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2439 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2440
2441 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2442 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2443 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2444 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2445
2446 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2447 {
2448 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2449 build_target_command_list (bl);
2450 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2451 bl->needs_update = 0;
2452 }
2453
2454 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2455 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2456 {
2457 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2458 {
2459 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2460 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2461 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2462
2463 Two important cases are:
2464 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2465 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2466 hardware breakpoint.
2467 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2468 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2469 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2470 so we undo.
2471
2472 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2473 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2474 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2475 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2476 gdb. */
2477 struct mem_region *mr
2478 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address);
2479
2480 if (mr)
2481 {
2482 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2483 {
2484 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2485
2486 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2487 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2488 else
2489 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2490
2491 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2492 {
2493 static int said = 0;
2494
2495 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2496 if (!said)
2497 {
2498 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2499 _("Note: automatically using "
2500 "hardware breakpoints for "
2501 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2502 said = 1;
2503 }
2504 }
2505 }
2506 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2507 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2508 {
2509 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2510 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2511 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2512 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2513 bl->owner->number,
2514 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2515 return 1;
2516 }
2517 }
2518 }
2519
2520 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2521 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2522 || bl->section == NULL
2523 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2524 {
2525 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2526 try
2527 {
2528 int val;
2529
2530 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2531 if (val)
2532 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2533 }
2534 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2535 {
2536 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2537 }
2538 }
2539 else
2540 {
2541 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2542 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2543 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2544 {
2545 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2546 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2547 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2548 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2549 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2550 bl->owner->number);
2551 else
2552 {
2553 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2554 bl->section);
2555 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2556 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2557 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2558
2559 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2560 try
2561 {
2562 int val;
2563
2564 bl->overlay_target_info.kind
2565 = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
2566 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2567 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2568 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2569 if (val)
2570 bp_excpt
2571 = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2572 }
2573 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2574 {
2575 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2576 }
2577
2578 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2579 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2580 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2581 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2582 bl->owner->number);
2583 }
2584 }
2585 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2586 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2587 {
2588 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2589 try
2590 {
2591 int val;
2592
2593 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2594 if (val)
2595 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2596 }
2597 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2598 {
2599 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2600 }
2601 }
2602 else
2603 {
2604 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2605 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2606 return 0;
2607 }
2608 }
2609
2610 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2611 {
2612 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2613
2614 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2615 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2616 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2617 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2618 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2619 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2620 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2621 errors as memory errors. */
2622 if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR
2623 && (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR
2624 || bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR)
2625 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2626 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2627 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2628 bl->address)))
2629 {
2630 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2631 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2632 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bl->owner);
2633 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2634 {
2635 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2636 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2637 bl->owner->number);
2638 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2639 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2640 "library breakpoints:\n");
2641 }
2642 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2643 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2644 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2645 return 0;
2646 }
2647 else
2648 {
2649 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2650 {
2651 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2652 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL;
2653 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2654 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2655 bl->owner->number,
2656 bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n");
2657 if (bp_excpt.message != NULL)
2658 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n",
2659 bp_excpt.what ());
2660 }
2661 else
2662 {
2663 if (bp_excpt.message == NULL)
2664 {
2665 std::string message
2666 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2667 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2668
2669 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2670 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2671 "%s\n",
2672 bl->owner->number, message.c_str ());
2673 }
2674 else
2675 {
2676 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2677 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2678 bl->owner->number,
2679 bp_excpt.what ());
2680 }
2681 }
2682 return 1;
2683
2684 }
2685 }
2686 else
2687 bl->inserted = 1;
2688
2689 return 0;
2690 }
2691
2692 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2693 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2694 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2695 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2696 {
2697 int val;
2698
2699 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2700 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2701
2702 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2703
2704 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2705 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2706 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2707 {
2708 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2709
2710 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2711 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2712 of this one. */
2713 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2714 if (loc != bl
2715 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2716 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2717 {
2718 bl->duplicate = 1;
2719 bl->inserted = 1;
2720 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2721 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2722 val = 0;
2723 break;
2724 }
2725
2726 if (val == 1)
2727 {
2728 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2729 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2730
2731 if (val)
2732 /* Back to the original value. */
2733 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2734 }
2735 }
2736
2737 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2738 }
2739
2740 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2741 {
2742 int val;
2743
2744 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2745 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2746
2747 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2748 if (val)
2749 {
2750 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2751
2752 if (val == 1)
2753 warning (_("\
2754 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2755 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2756 else
2757 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2758 }
2759
2760 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2761
2762 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2763 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2764 so just return success. */
2765 return 0;
2766 }
2767
2768 return 0;
2769 }
2770
2771 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2772 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2773 PSPACE anymore. */
2774
2775 void
2776 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2777 {
2778 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2779 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2780
2781 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2782 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2783 {
2784 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2785 delete_breakpoint (b);
2786 }
2787
2788 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2789 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2790 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2791 {
2792 struct bp_location *tmp;
2793
2794 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2795 {
2796 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2797 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2798 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2799 else
2800 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2801 if (tmp->next == loc)
2802 {
2803 tmp->next = loc->next;
2804 break;
2805 }
2806 }
2807 }
2808
2809 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2810 removed locations above. */
2811 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2812 }
2813
2814 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2815 Throws exception on any error.
2816 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2817 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2818 void
2819 insert_breakpoints (void)
2820 {
2821 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2822
2823 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2824 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2825 {
2826 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2827
2828 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2829 }
2830
2831 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
2832 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
2833 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. */
2834 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
2835 }
2836
2837 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
2838
2839 void
2840 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
2841 {
2842 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
2843
2844 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
2845 {
2846 callback (loc, NULL);
2847 }
2848 }
2849
2850 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2851 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2852 always-inserted mode. */
2853
2854 static void
2855 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2856 {
2857 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2858 int error_flag = 0;
2859 int val = 0;
2860 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2861 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2862 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
2863
2864 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2865
2866 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2867 there was an error. */
2868 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2869
2870 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2871
2872 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2873 {
2874 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2875 breakpoints. */
2876 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2877 continue;
2878
2879 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2880 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2881 deletion of breakpoints. */
2882 if (!bl->inserted || !bl->needs_update)
2883 continue;
2884
2885 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2886
2887 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2888 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2889 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2890 insert breakpoints. */
2891 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2892 && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution))
2893 continue;
2894
2895 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2896 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
2897 if (val)
2898 error_flag = val;
2899 }
2900
2901 if (error_flag)
2902 {
2903 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
2904 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2905 }
2906 }
2907
2908 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2909
2910 static void
2911 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2912 {
2913 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2914 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2915 int error_flag = 0;
2916 int val = 0;
2917 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2918 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2919 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
2920
2921 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2922
2923 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2924 there was an error. */
2925 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2926
2927 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2928
2929 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2930 {
2931 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2932 continue;
2933
2934 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
2935 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
2936 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2937 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
2938 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
2939 continue;
2940
2941 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2942
2943 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2944 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2945 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2946 insert breakpoints. */
2947 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2948 && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution))
2949 continue;
2950
2951 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2952 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
2953 if (val)
2954 error_flag = val;
2955 }
2956
2957 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
2958 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
2959 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2960 {
2961 int some_failed = 0;
2962 struct bp_location *loc;
2963
2964 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2965 continue;
2966
2967 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2968 continue;
2969
2970 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2971 continue;
2972
2973 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2974 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
2975 {
2976 some_failed = 1;
2977 break;
2978 }
2979 if (some_failed)
2980 {
2981 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2982 if (loc->inserted)
2983 remove_breakpoint (loc);
2984
2985 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2986 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert "
2987 "hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
2988 bpt->number);
2989 error_flag = -1;
2990 }
2991 }
2992
2993 if (error_flag)
2994 {
2995 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
2996 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
2997 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2998 {
2999 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3000 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3001 }
3002 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
3003 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3004 }
3005 }
3006
3007 /* Used when the program stops.
3008 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3009 removing a breakpoint location. */
3010
3011 int
3012 remove_breakpoints (void)
3013 {
3014 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3015 int val = 0;
3016
3017 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3018 {
3019 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3020 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
3021 }
3022 return val;
3023 }
3024
3025 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3026 that thread. */
3027
3028 static void
3029 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3030 {
3031 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3032
3033 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3034 {
3035 if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3036 {
3037 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3038
3039 printf_filtered (_("\
3040 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3041 b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
3042
3043 /* Hide it from the user. */
3044 b->number = 0;
3045 }
3046 }
3047 }
3048
3049 /* See breakpoint.h. */
3050
3051 void
3052 remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior *inf)
3053 {
3054 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3055 int val;
3056
3057 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3058 {
3059 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3060 continue;
3061
3062 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3063 {
3064 val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
3065 if (val != 0)
3066 return;
3067 }
3068 }
3069 }
3070
3071 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3072
3073 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3074 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3075 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3076 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3077 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3078 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3079 static void
3080 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3081 {
3082 if (internal)
3083 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3084 else
3085 {
3086 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3087 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3088 }
3089 }
3090
3091 static struct breakpoint *
3092 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3093 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3094 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3095 {
3096 symtab_and_line sal;
3097 sal.pc = address;
3098 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3099 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3100
3101 breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3102 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3103 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3104
3105 return b;
3106 }
3107
3108 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3109 {
3110 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3111 };
3112 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3113
3114 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3115 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3116 {
3117 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3118 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym {};
3119
3120 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3121 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES] {};
3122
3123 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3124 int longjmp_searched = 0;
3125
3126 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning
3127 references. */
3128 std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes;
3129
3130 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3131 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym {};
3132
3133 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3134 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym {};
3135
3136 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3137 int exception_searched = 0;
3138
3139 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning
3140 references. */
3141 std::vector<probe *> exception_probes;
3142 };
3143
3144 static const struct objfile_key<breakpoint_objfile_data>
3145 breakpoint_objfile_key;
3146
3147 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3148 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3149
3150 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3151
3152 static int
3153 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3154 {
3155 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3156 }
3157
3158 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3159 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3160
3161 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3162 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3163 {
3164 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3165
3166 bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.get (objfile);
3167 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3168 bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.emplace (objfile);
3169 return bp_objfile_data;
3170 }
3171
3172 static void
3173 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3174 {
3175 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3176
3177 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3178 {
3179 struct breakpoint *b;
3180 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3181 CORE_ADDR addr;
3182 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3183
3184 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3185
3186 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3187 continue;
3188
3189 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3190 {
3191 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3192
3193 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3194 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3195 {
3196 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3197 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3198 continue;
3199 }
3200 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3201 }
3202
3203 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3204 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3205 bp_overlay_event,
3206 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3207 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3208 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3209 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3210
3211 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3212 {
3213 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3214 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3215 }
3216 else
3217 {
3218 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3219 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3220 }
3221 }
3222 }
3223
3224 static void
3225 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3226 {
3227 struct program_space *pspace;
3228
3229 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3230
3231 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3232 {
3233 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3234
3235 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3236 {
3237 int i;
3238 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3239 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3240
3241 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3242
3243 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3244
3245 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3246 {
3247 std::vector<probe *> ret
3248 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3249
3250 if (!ret.empty ())
3251 {
3252 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3253 probe *p = ret[0];
3254
3255 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3256 {
3257 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3258 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3259 ret.clear ();
3260 }
3261 }
3262 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3263 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3264 }
3265
3266 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ())
3267 {
3268 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes)
3269 {
3270 struct breakpoint *b;
3271
3272 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3273 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3274 bp_longjmp_master,
3275 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3276 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3277 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3278 }
3279
3280 continue;
3281 }
3282
3283 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3284 continue;
3285
3286 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3287 {
3288 struct breakpoint *b;
3289 const char *func_name;
3290 CORE_ADDR addr;
3291 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3292
3293 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3294 continue;
3295
3296 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3297 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3298 {
3299 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3300
3301 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3302 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3303 {
3304 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3305 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3306 continue;
3307 }
3308 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3309 }
3310
3311 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3312 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3313 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3314 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3315 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3316 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3317 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3318 }
3319 }
3320 }
3321 }
3322
3323 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3324 static void
3325 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3326 {
3327 struct program_space *pspace;
3328 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3329
3330 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3331
3332 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3333 {
3334 CORE_ADDR addr;
3335
3336 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3337
3338 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3339 {
3340 struct breakpoint *b;
3341 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3342 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3343
3344 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3345
3346 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3347 continue;
3348
3349 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3350 {
3351 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3352
3353 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3354 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3355 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3356 {
3357 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3358 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3359 continue;
3360 }
3361 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3362 }
3363
3364 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3365 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3366 bp_std_terminate_master,
3367 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3368 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3369 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3370 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3371 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3372 }
3373 }
3374 }
3375
3376 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3377
3378 static void
3379 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3380 {
3381 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3382
3383 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3384 {
3385 struct breakpoint *b;
3386 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3387 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3388 CORE_ADDR addr;
3389 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3390
3391 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3392
3393 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3394 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3395 {
3396 std::vector<probe *> ret
3397 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3398
3399 if (!ret.empty ())
3400 {
3401 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3402 probe *p = ret[0];
3403
3404 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3405 {
3406 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3407 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3408 ret.clear ();
3409 }
3410 }
3411 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3412 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3413 }
3414
3415 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ())
3416 {
3417 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3418
3419 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes)
3420 {
3421 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3422 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3423 bp_exception_master,
3424 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3425 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3426 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3427 }
3428
3429 continue;
3430 }
3431
3432 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3433
3434 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3435 continue;
3436
3437 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3438
3439 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3440 {
3441 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3442
3443 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3444 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3445 {
3446 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3447 continue;
3448 }
3449
3450 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3451 }
3452
3453 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3454 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3455 current_top_target ());
3456 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3457 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3458 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3459 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3460 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3461 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3462 }
3463 }
3464
3465 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3466
3467 static int
3468 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
3469 {
3470 return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location.get ());
3471 }
3472
3473 void
3474 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3475 {
3476 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3477 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3478
3479 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3480 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3481 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3482 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3483 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3484 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3485 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3486 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3487 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3488 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3489 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3490
3491 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3492 {
3493 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3494 continue;
3495
3496 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3497 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3498 {
3499 delete_breakpoint (b);
3500 continue;
3501 }
3502
3503 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3504 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3505 {
3506 delete_breakpoint (b);
3507 continue;
3508 }
3509
3510 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3511 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3512 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3513 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3514 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3515 {
3516 delete_breakpoint (b);
3517 continue;
3518 }
3519
3520 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3521 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3522 {
3523 delete_breakpoint (b);
3524 continue;
3525 }
3526
3527 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3528 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3529 {
3530 delete_breakpoint (b);
3531 continue;
3532 }
3533
3534 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3535 after an exec. */
3536 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3537 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3538 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3539 {
3540 delete_breakpoint (b);
3541 continue;
3542 }
3543
3544 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3545 {
3546 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3547 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3548 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3549 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3550 continue;
3551 }
3552
3553 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3554 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3555 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3556 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3557 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3558 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3559
3560 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3561 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3562 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3563 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3564 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3565 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3566 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3567
3568 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3569 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3570 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3571 let finish_command delete it.
3572
3573 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3574 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3575 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3576 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3577 solib breakpoints.) */
3578
3579 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3580 {
3581 continue;
3582 }
3583
3584 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3585 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3586 a.out. */
3587 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
3588 {
3589 delete_breakpoint (b);
3590 continue;
3591 }
3592 }
3593 }
3594
3595 int
3596 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3597 {
3598 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3599 int val = 0;
3600 scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid);
3601 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3602
3603 if (ptid.pid () == inferior_ptid.pid ())
3604 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3605
3606 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3607 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3608 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3609 {
3610 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3611 continue;
3612
3613 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3614 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3615 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3616 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3617 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3618 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3619 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3620 continue;
3621
3622 if (bl->inserted)
3623 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3624 }
3625
3626 return val;
3627 }
3628
3629 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3630 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3631 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3632 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3633 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3634
3635 static int
3636 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
3637 {
3638 int val;
3639
3640 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3641 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3642
3643 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3644 This should not ever happen. */
3645 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3646
3647 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3648 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3649 {
3650 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3651 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3652 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3653
3654 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3655 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3656 || bl->section == NULL
3657 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3658 {
3659 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3660
3661 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3662 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3663 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3664 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3665 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3666 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3667 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3668 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3669 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3670 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3671 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3672 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3673 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3674 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3675 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3676 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3677 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3678 they should always be removed. */
3679 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3680 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3681 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3682 val = 0;
3683 else
3684 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3685 }
3686 else
3687 {
3688 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3689 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3690 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3691 {
3692 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3693 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3694 */
3695 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3696 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3697 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3698 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3699 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3700 else
3701 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3702 &bl->overlay_target_info,
3703 reason);
3704 }
3705 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3706 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3707 if (bl->inserted)
3708 {
3709 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3710 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3711 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3712 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3713
3714 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3715 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3716 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3717 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3718 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3719 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3720 else
3721 val = 0;
3722 }
3723 else
3724 {
3725 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3726 val = 0;
3727 }
3728 }
3729
3730 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3731 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3732 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3733 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3734 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3735 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3736 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3737 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3738 always-inserted mode. */
3739 if (val
3740 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3741 && (bl->shlib_disabled
3742 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
3743 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
3744 bl->address))))
3745 val = 0;
3746
3747 if (val)
3748 return val;
3749 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3750 }
3751 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3752 {
3753 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3754 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3755
3756 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3757 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3758
3759 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3760 if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
3761 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3762 bl->owner->number);
3763 }
3764 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
3765 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3766 && !bl->duplicate)
3767 {
3768 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3769 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3770
3771 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3772 if (val)
3773 return val;
3774
3775 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3776 }
3777
3778 return 0;
3779 }
3780
3781 static int
3782 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
3783 {
3784 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3785 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3786
3787 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3788 This should not ever happen. */
3789 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3790
3791 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
3792
3793 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3794
3795 return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
3796 }
3797
3798 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3799
3800 void
3801 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3802 {
3803 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3804
3805 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3806 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
3807 bl->inserted = 0;
3808 }
3809
3810 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3811 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3812
3813 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3814 between runs.
3815
3816 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3817 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3818 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3819
3820
3821
3822 void
3823 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
3824 {
3825 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3826 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
3827
3828 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3829 nothing to do. */
3830 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
3831 return;
3832
3833 mark_breakpoints_out ();
3834
3835 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3836 {
3837 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
3838 continue;
3839
3840 switch (b->type)
3841 {
3842 case bp_call_dummy:
3843 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
3844
3845 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
3846 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
3847 rid of it. */
3848
3849 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3850
3851 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
3852
3853 case bp_shlib_event:
3854
3855 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
3856 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
3857 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
3858 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
3859 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
3860
3861 (gdb) file prog-linux
3862 (gdb) run # native linux target
3863 ...
3864 (gdb) kill
3865 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
3866 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
3867 */
3868
3869 case bp_step_resume:
3870
3871 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
3872
3873 case bp_single_step:
3874
3875 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
3876
3877 delete_breakpoint (b);
3878 break;
3879
3880 case bp_watchpoint:
3881 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3882 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3883 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3884 {
3885 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
3886
3887 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
3888 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
3889 delete_breakpoint (b);
3890 else
3891 {
3892 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
3893 valid. New ones will be created in
3894 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
3895 The next update_global_location_list call will
3896 garbage collect them. */
3897 b->loc = NULL;
3898
3899 if (context == inf_starting)
3900 {
3901 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
3902 insert_breakpoints. */
3903 w->val.reset (nullptr);
3904 w->val_valid = false;
3905 }
3906 }
3907 }
3908 break;
3909 default:
3910 break;
3911 }
3912 }
3913
3914 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
3915 for (bp_location *bl : moribund_locations)
3916 decref_bp_location (&bl);
3917 moribund_locations.clear ();
3918 }
3919
3920 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
3921 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
3922 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
3923 match, not program space. */
3924
3925 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
3926 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
3927 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
3928 permanent breakpoint.
3929 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
3930 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
3931 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
3932 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
3933 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
3934
3935 enum breakpoint_here
3936 breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
3937 {
3938 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3939 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
3940
3941 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3942 {
3943 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3944 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3945 continue;
3946
3947 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3948 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3949 || bl->permanent)
3950 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
3951 {
3952 if (overlay_debugging
3953 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3954 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3955 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
3956 else if (bl->permanent)
3957 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
3958 else
3959 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
3960 }
3961 }
3962
3963 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
3964 }
3965
3966 /* See breakpoint.h. */
3967
3968 int
3969 breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace,
3970 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
3971 {
3972 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3973
3974 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3975 {
3976 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3977 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3978 continue;
3979
3980 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3981 || bl->permanent)
3982 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
3983 addr, len))
3984 {
3985 if (overlay_debugging
3986 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3987 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3988 {
3989 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
3990 continue;
3991 }
3992
3993 return 1;
3994 }
3995 }
3996
3997 return 0;
3998 }
3999
4000 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4001
4002 int
4003 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4004 {
4005 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
4006 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4007 return 1;
4008
4009 return 0;
4010 }
4011
4012 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4013 ASPACE. */
4014
4015 static int
4016 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4017 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4018 {
4019 if (bl->inserted
4020 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4021 aspace, pc))
4022 {
4023 if (overlay_debugging
4024 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4025 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4026 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4027 else
4028 return 1;
4029 }
4030 return 0;
4031 }
4032
4033 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4034
4035 int
4036 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4037 {
4038 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4039
4040 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4041 {
4042 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4043
4044 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4045 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4046 continue;
4047
4048 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4049 return 1;
4050 }
4051 return 0;
4052 }
4053
4054 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4055 inserted at PC. */
4056
4057 int
4058 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4059 CORE_ADDR pc)
4060 {
4061 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4062
4063 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4064 {
4065 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4066
4067 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4068 continue;
4069
4070 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4071 return 1;
4072 }
4073
4074 return 0;
4075 }
4076
4077 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4078
4079 int
4080 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4081 CORE_ADDR pc)
4082 {
4083 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4084
4085 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4086 {
4087 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4088
4089 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4090 continue;
4091
4092 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4093 return 1;
4094 }
4095
4096 return 0;
4097 }
4098
4099 int
4100 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace,
4101 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4102 {
4103 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4104
4105 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4106 {
4107 struct bp_location *loc;
4108
4109 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4110 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4111 continue;
4112
4113 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4114 continue;
4115
4116 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4117 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4118 {
4119 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4120
4121 /* Check for intersection. */
4122 l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
4123 h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4124 if (l < h)
4125 return 1;
4126 }
4127 }
4128 return 0;
4129 }
4130
4131 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4132
4133 bool
4134 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
4135 {
4136 return (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
4137 }
4138
4139 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4140 'next' chain. */
4141
4142 bpstats::~bpstats ()
4143 {
4144 if (bp_location_at != NULL)
4145 decref_bp_location (&bp_location_at);
4146 }
4147
4148 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4149 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4150
4151 void
4152 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4153 {
4154 bpstat p;
4155 bpstat q;
4156
4157 if (bsp == 0)
4158 return;
4159 p = *bsp;
4160 while (p != NULL)
4161 {
4162 q = p->next;
4163 delete p;
4164 p = q;
4165 }
4166 *bsp = NULL;
4167 }
4168
4169 bpstats::bpstats (const bpstats &other)
4170 : next (NULL),
4171 bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at),
4172 breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at),
4173 commands (other.commands),
4174 print (other.print),
4175 stop (other.stop),
4176 print_it (other.print_it)
4177 {
4178 if (other.old_val != NULL)
4179 old_val = release_value (value_copy (other.old_val.get ()));
4180 incref_bp_location (bp_location_at);
4181 }
4182
4183 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4184 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4185
4186 bpstat
4187 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4188 {
4189 bpstat p = NULL;
4190 bpstat tmp;
4191 bpstat retval = NULL;
4192
4193 if (bs == NULL)
4194 return bs;
4195
4196 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4197 {
4198 tmp = new bpstats (*bs);
4199
4200 if (p == NULL)
4201 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4202 retval = tmp;
4203 else
4204 p->next = tmp;
4205 p = tmp;
4206 }
4207 p->next = NULL;
4208 return retval;
4209 }
4210
4211 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4212
4213 bpstat
4214 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4215 {
4216 if (bsp == NULL)
4217 return NULL;
4218
4219 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4220 {
4221 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4222 return bsp;
4223 }
4224 return NULL;
4225 }
4226
4227 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4228
4229 bool
4230 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4231 {
4232 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4233 {
4234 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4235 {
4236 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4237 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4238 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4239 return true;
4240 }
4241 else
4242 {
4243 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4244 sig))
4245 return true;
4246 }
4247 }
4248
4249 return false;
4250 }
4251
4252 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4253 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4254 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4255 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4256
4257 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4258 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4259 we set it.
4260 Return 1 otherwise. */
4261
4262 int
4263 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4264 {
4265 struct breakpoint *b;
4266
4267 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4268 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4269
4270 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4271 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4272 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4273 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4274 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4275 if (b == NULL)
4276 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4277
4278 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4279 return 1;
4280 }
4281
4282 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4283
4284 void
4285 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4286 {
4287 bpstat bs;
4288
4289 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
4290 return;
4291
4292 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4293 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4294 {
4295 bs->commands = NULL;
4296 bs->old_val.reset (nullptr);
4297 }
4298 }
4299
4300 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4301
4302 static void
4303 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4304 {
4305 if (inferior_ptid != null_ptid)
4306 {
4307 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4308
4309 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4310 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4311 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4312 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4313 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4314 return;
4315 }
4316
4317 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4318 }
4319
4320 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4321 or its equivalent. */
4322
4323 static int
4324 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4325 {
4326 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4327 }
4328
4329 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4330 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4331 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4332 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4333
4334 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4335 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4336 bpstat of the current thread. */
4337
4338 static int
4339 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4340 {
4341 bpstat bs;
4342 int again = 0;
4343
4344 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4345 in bs->commands. */
4346 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4347 return 0;
4348
4349 scoped_restore save_executing
4350 = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1);
4351
4352 scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat ();
4353
4354 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4355 bs = *bsp;
4356
4357 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4358 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4359 {
4360 struct command_line *cmd = NULL;
4361
4362 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4363
4364 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4365 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4366 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4367 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4368 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4369 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4370 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4371 the tree when we're done. */
4372 counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands;
4373 bs->commands = NULL;
4374 if (ccmd != NULL)
4375 cmd = ccmd.get ();
4376 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4377 {
4378 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4379 cmd = cmd->next;
4380 }
4381
4382 while (cmd != NULL)
4383 {
4384 execute_control_command (cmd);
4385
4386 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4387 break;
4388 else
4389 cmd = cmd->next;
4390 }
4391
4392 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4393 {
4394 if (current_ui->async)
4395 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4396 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4397 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4398 ;
4399 else
4400 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4401 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4402 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4403 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4404 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4405 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4406 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4407 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4408 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4409 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4410 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4411 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4412 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4413 again = 1;
4414 break;
4415 }
4416 }
4417 return again;
4418 }
4419
4420 /* Helper for bpstat_do_actions. Get the current thread, if there's
4421 one, is alive and has execution. Return NULL otherwise. */
4422
4423 static thread_info *
4424 get_bpstat_thread ()
4425 {
4426 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution)
4427 return NULL;
4428
4429 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4430 if (tp->state == THREAD_EXITED || tp->executing)
4431 return NULL;
4432 return tp;
4433 }
4434
4435 void
4436 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4437 {
4438 auto cleanup_if_error = make_scope_exit (bpstat_clear_actions);
4439 thread_info *tp;
4440
4441 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4442 while ((tp = get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL)
4443 {
4444 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the
4445 inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next
4446 breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns
4447 false to indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4448 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp->control.stop_bpstat))
4449 break;
4450 }
4451
4452 cleanup_if_error.release ();
4453 }
4454
4455 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4456
4457 static void
4458 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4459 {
4460 if (val == NULL)
4461 fprintf_styled (stream, metadata_style.style (), _("<unreadable>"));
4462 else
4463 {
4464 struct value_print_options opts;
4465 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4466 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4467 }
4468 }
4469
4470 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4471 debugging multiple threads. */
4472
4473 void
4474 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
4475 {
4476 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4477 return;
4478
4479 uiout->text ("\n");
4480
4481 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4482 {
4483 const char *name;
4484 struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
4485
4486 uiout->text ("Thread ");
4487 uiout->field_string ("thread-id", print_thread_id (thr));
4488
4489 name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr);
4490 if (name != NULL)
4491 {
4492 uiout->text (" \"");
4493 uiout->field_string ("name", name);
4494 uiout->text ("\"");
4495 }
4496
4497 uiout->text (" hit ");
4498 }
4499 }
4500
4501 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4502 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4503 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4504 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4505 normal_stop(). */
4506
4507 static enum print_stop_action
4508 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4509 {
4510 switch (bs->print_it)
4511 {
4512 case print_it_noop:
4513 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4514 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4515 break;
4516
4517 case print_it_done:
4518 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4519 relevant messages. */
4520 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4521 break;
4522
4523 case print_it_normal:
4524 {
4525 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4526
4527 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4528 which has since been deleted. */
4529 if (b == NULL)
4530 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4531
4532 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4533 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4534 }
4535 break;
4536
4537 default:
4538 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4539 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4540 break;
4541 }
4542 }
4543
4544 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4545
4546 static void
4547 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4548 {
4549 bool any_deleted = !current_program_space->deleted_solibs.empty ();
4550 bool any_added = !current_program_space->added_solibs.empty ();
4551
4552 if (!is_catchpoint)
4553 {
4554 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4555 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4556 else
4557 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4558 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4559 }
4560
4561 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4562 current_uiout->field_string ("reason",
4563 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4564
4565 if (any_deleted)
4566 {
4567 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded "));
4568 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed");
4569 for (int ix = 0; ix < current_program_space->deleted_solibs.size (); ix++)
4570 {
4571 const std::string &name = current_program_space->deleted_solibs[ix];
4572
4573 if (ix > 0)
4574 current_uiout->text (" ");
4575 current_uiout->field_string ("library", name);
4576 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4577 }
4578 }
4579
4580 if (any_added)
4581 {
4582 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded "));
4583 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added");
4584 bool first = true;
4585 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
4586 {
4587 if (!first)
4588 current_uiout->text (" ");
4589 first = false;
4590 current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name);
4591 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4592 }
4593 }
4594 }
4595
4596 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4597 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4598 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4599 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4600 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4601 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4602 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4603 routine is one of:
4604
4605 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4606 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4607 code to print the location. An example is
4608 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4609 the location.
4610 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4611 to also print the location part of the message.
4612 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4613 don't require a location appended to the end.
4614 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4615 further info to be printed. */
4616
4617 enum print_stop_action
4618 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4619 {
4620 enum print_stop_action val;
4621
4622 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4623 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4624 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4625 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4626 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4627 {
4628 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4629 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4630 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4631 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4632 return val;
4633 }
4634
4635 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4636 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4637 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4638 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4639 {
4640 print_solib_event (0);
4641 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4642 }
4643
4644 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4645 with and nothing was printed. */
4646 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4647 }
4648
4649 /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */
4650
4651 static bool
4652 breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp)
4653 {
4654 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4655 bool res = value_true (evaluate_expression (exp));
4656
4657 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4658 return res;
4659 }
4660
4661 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4662
4663 bpstats::bpstats (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4664 : next (NULL),
4665 bp_location_at (bl),
4666 breakpoint_at (bl->owner),
4667 commands (NULL),
4668 print (0),
4669 stop (0),
4670 print_it (print_it_normal)
4671 {
4672 incref_bp_location (bl);
4673 **bs_link_pointer = this;
4674 *bs_link_pointer = &next;
4675 }
4676
4677 bpstats::bpstats ()
4678 : next (NULL),
4679 bp_location_at (NULL),
4680 breakpoint_at (NULL),
4681 commands (NULL),
4682 print (0),
4683 stop (0),
4684 print_it (print_it_normal)
4685 {
4686 }
4687 \f
4688 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4689 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4690
4691 int
4692 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4693 {
4694 bool stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4695 CORE_ADDR addr;
4696 struct breakpoint *b;
4697
4698 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4699 {
4700 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4701 as not triggered. */
4702 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4703 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4704 {
4705 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4706
4707 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4708 }
4709
4710 return 0;
4711 }
4712
4713 if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_top_target (), &addr))
4714 {
4715 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4716 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4717 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4718 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4719 {
4720 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4721
4722 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4723 }
4724
4725 return 1;
4726 }
4727
4728 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4729 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4730 triggered. */
4731
4732 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4733 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4734 {
4735 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4736 struct bp_location *loc;
4737
4738 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4739 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4740 {
4741 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4742 {
4743 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4744 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4745
4746 if (newaddr == start)
4747 {
4748 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4749 break;
4750 }
4751 }
4752 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4753 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (current_top_target (),
4754 addr, loc->address,
4755 loc->length))
4756 {
4757 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4758 break;
4759 }
4760 }
4761 }
4762
4763 return 1;
4764 }
4765
4766 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */
4767 enum wp_check_result
4768 {
4769 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4770 WP_DELETED = 1,
4771
4772 /* The value has changed. */
4773 WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2,
4774
4775 /* The value has not changed. */
4776 WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3,
4777
4778 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4779 WP_IGNORE = 4,
4780 };
4781
4782 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4783 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4784
4785 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4786 changed. */
4787
4788 static wp_check_result
4789 watchpoint_check (bpstat bs)
4790 {
4791 struct watchpoint *b;
4792 struct frame_info *fr;
4793 int within_current_scope;
4794
4795 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4796 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4797 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4798
4799 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4800 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4801 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4802 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4803 return WP_IGNORE;
4804
4805 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4806 within_current_scope = 1;
4807 else
4808 {
4809 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4810 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4811 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4812
4813 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4814 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4815 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4816 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4817 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4818 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4819 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4820 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4821 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4822 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
4823 return WP_IGNORE;
4824
4825 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
4826 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
4827
4828 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
4829 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
4830 if (within_current_scope)
4831 {
4832 struct symbol *function;
4833
4834 function = get_frame_function (fr);
4835 if (function == NULL
4836 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
4837 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
4838 within_current_scope = 0;
4839 }
4840
4841 if (within_current_scope)
4842 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
4843 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
4844 the user. */
4845 select_frame (fr);
4846 }
4847
4848 if (within_current_scope)
4849 {
4850 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
4851 time before we return to the command level and call
4852 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
4853 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
4854
4855 int pc = 0;
4856 struct value *mark;
4857 struct value *new_val;
4858
4859 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4860 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
4861 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
4862 a mask watchpoint. */
4863 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4864
4865 mark = value_mark ();
4866 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
4867
4868 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
4869 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
4870
4871 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
4872 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
4873 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
4874 not what we want. */
4875 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
4876 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val.get (),
4877 new_val)))
4878 {
4879 bs->old_val = b->val;
4880 b->val = release_value (new_val);
4881 b->val_valid = true;
4882 if (new_val != NULL)
4883 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4884 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4885 }
4886 else
4887 {
4888 /* Nothing changed. */
4889 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4890 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
4891 }
4892 }
4893 else
4894 {
4895 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
4896 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
4897 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
4898 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
4899 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
4900 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
4901 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
4902 the first value assigned). */
4903 /* We print all the stop information in
4904 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
4905 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
4906 already. So we have no choice but print the information
4907 here. */
4908
4909 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
4910 {
4911 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
4912
4913 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4914 uiout->field_string
4915 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
4916 uiout->message ("\nWatchpoint %pF deleted because the program has "
4917 "left the block in\n"
4918 "which its expression is valid.\n",
4919 signed_field ("wpnum", b->number));
4920 }
4921
4922 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
4923 b->commands = NULL;
4924 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
4925
4926 return WP_DELETED;
4927 }
4928 }
4929
4930 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
4931 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
4932 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
4933
4934 static int
4935 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
4936 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
4937 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4938 {
4939 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
4940
4941 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
4942 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
4943
4944 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
4945 }
4946
4947 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
4948 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
4949
4950 static void
4951 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
4952 {
4953 const struct bp_location *bl;
4954 struct watchpoint *b;
4955
4956 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
4957 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
4958 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
4959 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4960 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
4961
4962 {
4963 int must_check_value = 0;
4964
4965 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
4966 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
4967 watched value. */
4968 must_check_value = 1;
4969 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
4970 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
4971 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
4972 this watchpoint. */
4973 must_check_value = 1;
4974 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
4975 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
4976 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
4977 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
4978 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
4979 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
4980 must_check_value = 1;
4981
4982 if (must_check_value)
4983 {
4984 wp_check_result e;
4985
4986 try
4987 {
4988 e = watchpoint_check (bs);
4989 }
4990 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
4991 {
4992 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
4993 "Error evaluating expression "
4994 "for watchpoint %d\n",
4995 b->number);
4996
4997 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
4998 {
4999 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
5000 b->number);
5001 }
5002 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5003 e = WP_DELETED;
5004 }
5005
5006 switch (e)
5007 {
5008 case WP_DELETED:
5009 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5010 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5011 /* Stop. */
5012 break;
5013 case WP_IGNORE:
5014 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5015 bs->stop = 0;
5016 break;
5017 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5018 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5019 {
5020 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5021
5022 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5023 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5024 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5025 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5026 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5027 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5028 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5029 old value.
5030
5031 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5032 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5033 happen:
5034
5035 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5036 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5037 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5038 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5039
5040 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5041 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5042 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5043 watchpoint.
5044
5045 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5046 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5047 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5048 changes. This still gives false positives when
5049 the program writes the same value to memory as
5050 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5051 it for a read), but it's much better than
5052 nothing. */
5053
5054 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5055
5056 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5057 {
5058 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5059
5060 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5061 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5062 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5063 {
5064 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5065 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5066
5067 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5068 == watch_triggered_yes)
5069 {
5070 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5071 break;
5072 }
5073 }
5074 }
5075
5076 if (other_write_watchpoint
5077 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5078 {
5079 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5080 and the value changed since the last time we
5081 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5082 Ignore it. */
5083 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5084 bs->stop = 0;
5085 }
5086 }
5087 break;
5088 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5089 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5090 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5091 {
5092 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5093 the value hasn't changed. */
5094 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5095 bs->stop = 0;
5096 }
5097 /* Stop. */
5098 break;
5099 default:
5100 /* Can't happen. */
5101 break;
5102 }
5103 }
5104 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5105 {
5106 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5107 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5108 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5109 anything for this watchpoint. */
5110 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5111 bs->stop = 0;
5112 }
5113 }
5114 }
5115
5116 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5117 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5118 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5119 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5120
5121 static void
5122 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, thread_info *thread)
5123 {
5124 const struct bp_location *bl;
5125 struct breakpoint *b;
5126 /* Assume stop. */
5127 bool condition_result = true;
5128 struct expression *cond;
5129
5130 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5131
5132 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5133 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5134 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5135 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5136 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5137
5138 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5139 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5140 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5141
5142 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5143 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5144 {
5145 bs->stop = 0;
5146 return;
5147 }
5148
5149 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5150 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5151 thread/task. */
5152 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread->global_num)
5153 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (thread)))
5154 {
5155 bs->stop = 0;
5156 return;
5157 }
5158
5159 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5160 implemented. */
5161 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5162
5163 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5164 {
5165 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5166
5167 cond = w->cond_exp.get ();
5168 }
5169 else
5170 cond = bl->cond.get ();
5171
5172 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5173 {
5174 int within_current_scope = 1;
5175 struct watchpoint * w;
5176
5177 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5178 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5179 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5180 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5181 function call. */
5182 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5183
5184 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5185 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5186 else
5187 w = NULL;
5188
5189 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5190 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5191 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5192 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5193 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5194 call site. */
5195 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5196 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5197 else
5198 {
5199 struct frame_info *frame;
5200
5201 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5202 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5203 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5204 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5205 really matter which instantiation of the function
5206 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5207 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5208 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5209 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5210 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5211 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5212 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5213 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5214 intuitive. */
5215 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5216 if (frame != NULL)
5217 select_frame (frame);
5218 else
5219 within_current_scope = 0;
5220 }
5221 if (within_current_scope)
5222 {
5223 try
5224 {
5225 condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond);
5226 }
5227 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
5228 {
5229 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5230 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n");
5231 }
5232 }
5233 else
5234 {
5235 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5236 "in the current scope"));
5237 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5238 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5239 }
5240 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5241 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5242 }
5243
5244 if (cond && !condition_result)
5245 {
5246 bs->stop = 0;
5247 }
5248 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5249 {
5250 b->ignore_count--;
5251 bs->stop = 0;
5252 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5253 ++(b->hit_count);
5254 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5255 }
5256 }
5257
5258 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5259 on the current target. */
5260
5261 static int
5262 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5263 {
5264 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5265 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5266 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5267 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5268 }
5269
5270 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5271
5272 bpstat
5273 build_bpstat_chain (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5274 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5275 {
5276 struct breakpoint *b;
5277 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5278
5279 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5280 {
5281 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5282 continue;
5283
5284 for (bp_location *bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5285 {
5286 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5287 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5288 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5289 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5290 checked all locations already. */
5291 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5292 break;
5293
5294 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5295 continue;
5296
5297 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5298 continue;
5299
5300 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5301 matches. */
5302
5303 bpstat bs = new bpstats (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5304 explain stop. */
5305
5306 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5307 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5308 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5309 bs->stop = 1;
5310 bs->print = 1;
5311
5312 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5313 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5314 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5315 iteration. */
5316 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5317 {
5318 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5319
5320 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5321 }
5322 }
5323 }
5324
5325 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5326 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5327 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5328 {
5329 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
5330 {
5331 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5332 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5333 {
5334 bpstat bs = new bpstats (loc, &bs_link);
5335 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5336 bs->stop = 0;
5337 bs->print = 0;
5338 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5339 }
5340 }
5341 }
5342
5343 return bs_head;
5344 }
5345
5346 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5347
5348 bpstat
5349 bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace,
5350 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, thread_info *thread,
5351 const struct target_waitstatus *ws,
5352 bpstat stop_chain)
5353 {
5354 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5355 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5356 bpstat bs_head = stop_chain;
5357 bpstat bs;
5358 int need_remove_insert;
5359 int removed_any;
5360
5361 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5362 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5363 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5364 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5365 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5366 inferior function calls. */
5367 if (bs_head == NULL)
5368 bs_head = build_bpstat_chain (aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5369
5370 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5371 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5372 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5373 "catch unload". */
5374 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5375 {
5376 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5377 {
5378 handle_solib_event ();
5379 break;
5380 }
5381 }
5382
5383 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5384 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5385 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5386
5387 removed_any = 0;
5388
5389 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5390 {
5391 if (!bs->stop)
5392 continue;
5393
5394 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5395 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5396 if (bs->stop)
5397 {
5398 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, thread);
5399
5400 if (bs->stop)
5401 {
5402 ++(b->hit_count);
5403 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5404
5405 /* We will stop here. */
5406 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5407 {
5408 --(b->enable_count);
5409 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5410 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5411 removed_any = 1;
5412 }
5413 if (b->silent)
5414 bs->print = 0;
5415 bs->commands = b->commands;
5416 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5417 ? bs->commands.get () : NULL))
5418 bs->print = 0;
5419
5420 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5421 }
5422
5423 }
5424
5425 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5426 print. */
5427 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5428 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5429 }
5430
5431 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5432 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5433 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5434 done later. */
5435 need_remove_insert = 0;
5436 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5437 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5438 if (!bs->stop
5439 && bs->breakpoint_at
5440 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5441 {
5442 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5443
5444 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5445 need_remove_insert = 1;
5446 }
5447
5448 if (need_remove_insert)
5449 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5450 else if (removed_any)
5451 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5452
5453 return bs_head;
5454 }
5455
5456 static void
5457 handle_jit_event (void)
5458 {
5459 struct frame_info *frame;
5460 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5461
5462 if (debug_infrun)
5463 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "handling bp_jit_event\n");
5464
5465 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5466 breakpoint_re_set. */
5467 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
5468
5469 frame = get_current_frame ();
5470 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5471
5472 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5473
5474 target_terminal::inferior ();
5475 }
5476
5477 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5478
5479 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5480
5481 struct bpstat_what
5482 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5483 {
5484 struct bpstat_what retval;
5485 bpstat bs;
5486
5487 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5488 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5489 retval.is_longjmp = false;
5490
5491 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5492 {
5493 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5494 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5495 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5496 enum bptype bptype;
5497
5498 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5499 {
5500 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5501 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5502 bptype = bp_none;
5503 }
5504 else
5505 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5506
5507 switch (bptype)
5508 {
5509 case bp_none:
5510 break;
5511 case bp_breakpoint:
5512 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5513 case bp_single_step:
5514 case bp_until:
5515 case bp_finish:
5516 case bp_shlib_event:
5517 if (bs->stop)
5518 {
5519 if (bs->print)
5520 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5521 else
5522 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5523 }
5524 else
5525 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5526 break;
5527 case bp_watchpoint:
5528 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5529 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5530 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5531 if (bs->stop)
5532 {
5533 if (bs->print)
5534 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5535 else
5536 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5537 }
5538 else
5539 {
5540 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5541 This requires no further action. */
5542 }
5543 break;
5544 case bp_longjmp:
5545 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5546 case bp_exception:
5547 if (bs->stop)
5548 {
5549 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5550 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5551 }
5552 else
5553 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5554 break;
5555 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5556 case bp_exception_resume:
5557 if (bs->stop)
5558 {
5559 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5560 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5561 }
5562 else
5563 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5564 break;
5565 case bp_step_resume:
5566 if (bs->stop)
5567 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5568 else
5569 {
5570 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5571 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5572 }
5573 break;
5574 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5575 if (bs->stop)
5576 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5577 else
5578 {
5579 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5580 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5581 }
5582 break;
5583 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5584 case bp_thread_event:
5585 case bp_overlay_event:
5586 case bp_longjmp_master:
5587 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5588 case bp_exception_master:
5589 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5590 break;
5591 case bp_catchpoint:
5592 if (bs->stop)
5593 {
5594 if (bs->print)
5595 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5596 else
5597 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5598 }
5599 else
5600 {
5601 /* Some catchpoints are implemented with breakpoints.
5602 For those, we need to step over the breakpoint. */
5603 if (bs->bp_location_at->loc_type != bp_loc_other)
5604 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5605 }
5606 break;
5607 case bp_jit_event:
5608 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5609 break;
5610 case bp_call_dummy:
5611 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5612 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5613 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5614 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5615 break;
5616 case bp_std_terminate:
5617 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5618 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5619 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5620 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5621 break;
5622 case bp_tracepoint:
5623 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5624 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5625 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5626 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5627 out already. */
5628 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5629 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5630 break;
5631 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5632 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5633 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5634 break;
5635 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5636 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5637 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5638 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5639 break;
5640
5641 case bp_dprintf:
5642 if (bs->stop)
5643 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5644 else
5645 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5646 break;
5647
5648 default:
5649 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5650 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5651 }
5652
5653 retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5654 }
5655
5656 return retval;
5657 }
5658
5659 void
5660 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
5661 {
5662 bpstat bs;
5663
5664 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5665 {
5666 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5667
5668 if (b == NULL)
5669 continue;
5670 switch (b->type)
5671 {
5672 case bp_jit_event:
5673 handle_jit_event ();
5674 break;
5675 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5676 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5677 break;
5678 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5679 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5680 break;
5681 }
5682 }
5683 }
5684
5685 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5686
5687 bool
5688 bpstat_should_step ()
5689 {
5690 struct breakpoint *b;
5691
5692 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5693 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5694 return true;
5695 return false;
5696 }
5697
5698 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5699
5700 bool
5701 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5702 {
5703 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5704 if (bs->stop)
5705 return true;
5706
5707 return false;
5708 }
5709
5710 \f
5711
5712 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5713 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5714 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5715
5716 static char *
5717 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5718 {
5719 static char wrap_indent[80];
5720 int i, total_width, width, align;
5721 const char *text;
5722
5723 total_width = 0;
5724 for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5725 {
5726 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5727 {
5728 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5729 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5730 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5731
5732 return wrap_indent;
5733 }
5734
5735 total_width += width + 1;
5736 }
5737
5738 return NULL;
5739 }
5740
5741 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5742 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5743
5744 "host": Host evals condition.
5745 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5746 "target": Target evals condition.
5747 */
5748
5749 static const char *
5750 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5751 {
5752 struct bp_location *bl;
5753 char host_evals = 0;
5754 char target_evals = 0;
5755
5756 if (!b)
5757 return NULL;
5758
5759 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5760 return NULL;
5761
5762 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5763 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5764 return condition_evaluation_host;
5765
5766 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5767 {
5768 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5769 target_evals++;
5770 else
5771 host_evals++;
5772 }
5773
5774 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5775 return condition_evaluation_both;
5776 else if (target_evals)
5777 return condition_evaluation_target;
5778 else
5779 return condition_evaluation_host;
5780 }
5781
5782 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5783 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5784
5785 static const char *
5786 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5787 {
5788 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5789 return NULL;
5790
5791 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5792 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5793 return condition_evaluation_host;
5794
5795 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5796 return condition_evaluation_target;
5797 else
5798 return condition_evaluation_host;
5799 }
5800
5801 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5802
5803 static void
5804 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5805 struct bp_location *loc)
5806 {
5807 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5808
5809 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
5810
5811 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5812 loc = NULL;
5813
5814 if (loc != NULL)
5815 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5816
5817 if (b->display_canonical)
5818 uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5819 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
5820 {
5821 const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol;
5822
5823 if (sym)
5824 {
5825 uiout->text ("in ");
5826 uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (),
5827 function_name_style.style ());
5828 uiout->text (" ");
5829 uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5830 uiout->text ("at ");
5831 }
5832 uiout->field_string ("file",
5833 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab),
5834 file_name_style.style ());
5835 uiout->text (":");
5836
5837 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5838 uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
5839
5840 uiout->field_signed ("line", loc->line_number);
5841 }
5842 else if (loc)
5843 {
5844 string_file stb;
5845
5846 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb,
5847 demangle, "");
5848 uiout->field_stream ("at", stb);
5849 }
5850 else
5851 {
5852 uiout->field_string ("pending",
5853 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5854 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
5855 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
5856 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
5857 if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL)
5858 {
5859 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
5860 uiout->text (",");
5861 else
5862 uiout->text (" ");
5863 uiout->text (b->extra_string);
5864 }
5865 }
5866
5867 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
5868 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5869 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
5870 {
5871 uiout->text (" (");
5872 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
5873 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
5874 uiout->text (")");
5875 }
5876 }
5877
5878 static const char *
5879 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
5880 {
5881 struct ep_type_description
5882 {
5883 enum bptype type;
5884 const char *description;
5885 };
5886 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
5887 {
5888 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
5889 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
5890 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
5891 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
5892 {bp_until, "until"},
5893 {bp_finish, "finish"},
5894 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
5895 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
5896 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
5897 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
5898 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
5899 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
5900 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
5901 {bp_exception, "exception"},
5902 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
5903 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
5904 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
5905 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
5906 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
5907 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
5908 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
5909 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
5910 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
5911 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
5912 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
5913 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
5914 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
5915 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
5916 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
5917 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
5918 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
5919 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
5920 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
5921 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
5922 };
5923
5924 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
5925 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
5926 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5927 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
5928 (int) type);
5929
5930 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
5931 }
5932
5933 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
5934 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
5935
5936 static void
5937 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
5938 const char *field_name,
5939 const std::vector<int> &inf_nums,
5940 int mi_only)
5941 {
5942 int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p ();
5943
5944 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
5945 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
5946 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
5947 return;
5948
5949 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name);
5950
5951 for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++)
5952 {
5953 if (is_mi)
5954 {
5955 char mi_group[10];
5956
5957 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]);
5958 uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group);
5959 }
5960 else
5961 {
5962 if (i == 0)
5963 uiout->text (" inf ");
5964 else
5965 uiout->text (", ");
5966
5967 uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i]));
5968 }
5969 }
5970 }
5971
5972 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. If RAW_LOC, print raw breakpoint locations
5973 instead of going via breakpoint_ops::print_one. This makes "maint
5974 info breakpoints" show the software breakpoint locations of
5975 catchpoints, which are considered internal implementation
5976 detail. */
5977
5978 static void
5979 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5980 struct bp_location *loc,
5981 int loc_number,
5982 struct bp_location **last_loc,
5983 int allflag, bool raw_loc)
5984 {
5985 struct command_line *l;
5986 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
5987
5988 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5989 int header_of_multiple = 0;
5990 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
5991 struct value_print_options opts;
5992
5993 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5994
5995 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
5996 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
5997 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
5998 if (loc == NULL
5999 && (b->loc != NULL
6000 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6001 header_of_multiple = 1;
6002 if (loc == NULL)
6003 loc = b->loc;
6004
6005 annotate_record ();
6006
6007 /* 1 */
6008 annotate_field (0);
6009 if (part_of_multiple)
6010 uiout->field_fmt ("number", "%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6011 else
6012 uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
6013
6014 /* 2 */
6015 annotate_field (1);
6016 if (part_of_multiple)
6017 uiout->field_skip ("type");
6018 else
6019 uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type));
6020
6021 /* 3 */
6022 annotate_field (2);
6023 if (part_of_multiple)
6024 uiout->field_skip ("disp");
6025 else
6026 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6027
6028 /* 4 */
6029 annotate_field (3);
6030 if (part_of_multiple)
6031 uiout->field_string ("enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6032 else
6033 uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6034
6035 /* 5 and 6 */
6036 if (!raw_loc && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6037 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6038 else
6039 {
6040 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6041 {
6042 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6043
6044 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6045 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6046 is relatively readable). */
6047 if (opts.addressprint)
6048 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
6049 annotate_field (5);
6050 uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string);
6051 }
6052 else if (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b)
6053 || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b))
6054 {
6055 if (opts.addressprint)
6056 {
6057 annotate_field (4);
6058 if (header_of_multiple)
6059 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>",
6060 metadata_style.style ());
6061 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6062 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>",
6063 metadata_style.style ());
6064 else
6065 uiout->field_core_addr ("addr",
6066 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6067 }
6068 annotate_field (5);
6069 if (!header_of_multiple)
6070 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6071 if (b->loc)
6072 *last_loc = b->loc;
6073 }
6074 }
6075
6076 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6077 {
6078 std::vector<int> inf_nums;
6079 int mi_only = 1;
6080
6081 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
6082 {
6083 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6084 inf_nums.push_back (inf->num);
6085 }
6086
6087 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6088 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6089 if (allflag
6090 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6091 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6092 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6093 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6094 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6095 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6096 mi_only = 0;
6097 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only);
6098 }
6099
6100 if (!part_of_multiple)
6101 {
6102 if (b->thread != -1)
6103 {
6104 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6105 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6106 uiout->text (" thread ");
6107 uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread);
6108 }
6109 else if (b->task != 0)
6110 {
6111 uiout->text (" task ");
6112 uiout->field_signed ("task", b->task);
6113 }
6114 }
6115
6116 uiout->text ("\n");
6117
6118 if (!part_of_multiple)
6119 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6120
6121 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6122 {
6123 annotate_field (6);
6124 uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6125 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6126 the frame ID. */
6127 uiout->field_core_addr ("frame",
6128 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6129 uiout->text ("\n");
6130 }
6131
6132 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6133 {
6134 annotate_field (7);
6135 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6136 uiout->text ("\ttrace only if ");
6137 else
6138 uiout->text ("\tstop only if ");
6139 uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string);
6140
6141 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6142 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6143 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6144 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6145 == condition_evaluation_target)
6146 {
6147 uiout->message (" (%pF evals)",
6148 string_field ("evaluated-by",
6149 bp_condition_evaluator (b)));
6150 }
6151 uiout->text ("\n");
6152 }
6153
6154 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6155 {
6156 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6157 uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread ");
6158 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6159 uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread);
6160 else
6161 {
6162 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
6163
6164 uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr));
6165 }
6166 uiout->text ("\n");
6167 }
6168
6169 if (!part_of_multiple)
6170 {
6171 if (b->hit_count)
6172 {
6173 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6174 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6175 uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint");
6176 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6177 uiout->text ("\ttracepoint");
6178 else
6179 uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint");
6180 uiout->text (" already hit ");
6181 uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count);
6182 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6183 uiout->text (" time\n");
6184 else
6185 uiout->text (" times\n");
6186 }
6187 else
6188 {
6189 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6190 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6191 uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count);
6192 }
6193 }
6194
6195 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6196 {
6197 annotate_field (8);
6198 uiout->message ("\tignore next %pF hits\n",
6199 signed_field ("ignore", b->ignore_count));
6200 }
6201
6202 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6203 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6204 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6205 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6206 {
6207 annotate_field (8);
6208 uiout->text ("\tdisable after ");
6209 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6210 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6211 if (b->ignore_count)
6212 uiout->text ("additional ");
6213 else
6214 uiout->text ("next ");
6215 uiout->field_signed ("enable", b->enable_count);
6216 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6217 }
6218
6219 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6220 {
6221 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6222
6223 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6224 {
6225 uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage ");
6226 uiout->field_signed ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6227 uiout->text (" bytes\n");
6228 }
6229 }
6230
6231 l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
6232 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6233 {
6234 annotate_field (9);
6235 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "script");
6236 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6237 }
6238
6239 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6240 {
6241 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6242
6243 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6244 {
6245 annotate_field (10);
6246 uiout->text ("\tpass count ");
6247 uiout->field_signed ("pass", t->pass_count);
6248 uiout->text (" \n");
6249 }
6250
6251 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6252 pending. */
6253 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6254 {
6255 annotate_field (11);
6256
6257 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6258 uiout->field_string ("installed",
6259 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6260 else
6261 {
6262 if (loc->inserted)
6263 uiout->text ("\t");
6264 else
6265 uiout->text ("\tnot ");
6266 uiout->text ("installed on target\n");
6267 }
6268 }
6269 }
6270
6271 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple)
6272 {
6273 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6274 {
6275 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6276
6277 uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string);
6278 }
6279 else if (b->location != NULL
6280 && event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()) != NULL)
6281 uiout->field_string ("original-location",
6282 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
6283 }
6284 }
6285
6286 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6287
6288 bool fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally = false;
6289
6290 static void
6291 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6292 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6293 int allflag)
6294 {
6295 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6296 bool use_fixed_output
6297 = (uiout->test_flags (fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output)
6298 || fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally);
6299
6300 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> bkpt_tuple_emitter (gdb::in_place, uiout, "bkpt");
6301 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag, false);
6302
6303 /* The mi2 broken format: the main breakpoint tuple ends here, the locations
6304 are outside. */
6305 if (!use_fixed_output)
6306 bkpt_tuple_emitter.reset ();
6307
6308 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6309 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6310 locations, if any. */
6311 if (b->ops == NULL
6312 || b->ops->print_one == NULL
6313 || allflag)
6314 {
6315 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6316 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6317 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6318 situation.
6319
6320 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6321 internally, that's not a property exposed to users.
6322
6323 Likewise, while catchpoints may be implemented with
6324 breakpoints (e.g., catch throw), that's not a property
6325 exposed to users. We do however display the internal
6326 breakpoint locations with "maint info breakpoints". */
6327 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6328 && (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b)
6329 || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b))
6330 && (allflag
6331 || (b->loc && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))))
6332 {
6333 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_list> locations_list;
6334
6335 /* For MI version <= 2, keep the behavior where GDB outputs an invalid
6336 MI record. For later versions, place breakpoint locations in a
6337 list. */
6338 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && use_fixed_output)
6339 locations_list.emplace (uiout, "locations");
6340
6341 int n = 1;
6342 for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6343 {
6344 ui_out_emit_tuple loc_tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL);
6345 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
6346 allflag, allflag);
6347 }
6348 }
6349 }
6350 }
6351
6352 static int
6353 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6354 {
6355 int print_address_bits = 0;
6356 struct bp_location *loc;
6357
6358 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6359 address to print. */
6360 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
6361 return 0;
6362
6363 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6364 {
6365 int addr_bit;
6366
6367 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6368 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6369 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6370 }
6371
6372 return print_address_bits;
6373 }
6374
6375 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6376
6377 void
6378 print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b)
6379 {
6380 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6381 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6382 }
6383
6384 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6385 internal or momentary. */
6386
6387 int
6388 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6389 {
6390 return b->number > 0;
6391 }
6392
6393 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6394
6395 int
6396 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6397 {
6398 return b->loc == NULL;
6399 }
6400
6401 /* Print information on breakpoints (including watchpoints and tracepoints).
6402
6403 If non-NULL, BP_NUM_LIST is a list of numbers and number ranges as
6404 understood by number_or_range_parser. Only breakpoints included in this
6405 list are then printed.
6406
6407 If SHOW_INTERNAL is true, print internal breakpoints.
6408
6409 If FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6410 ones for which it returns true.
6411
6412 Return the total number of breakpoints listed. */
6413
6414 static int
6415 breakpoint_1 (const char *bp_num_list, bool show_internal,
6416 bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6417 {
6418 struct breakpoint *b;
6419 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6420 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6421 struct value_print_options opts;
6422 int print_address_bits = 0;
6423 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6424 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6425
6426 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6427
6428 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6429 required for address fields. */
6430 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6431 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6432 {
6433 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6434 if (filter && !filter (b))
6435 continue;
6436
6437 /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6438 accept. Skip the others. */
6439 if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0')
6440 {
6441 if (show_internal && parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b->number)
6442 continue;
6443 if (!show_internal && !number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b->number))
6444 continue;
6445 }
6446
6447 if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6448 {
6449 int addr_bit, type_len;
6450
6451 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6452 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6453 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6454
6455 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6456 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6457 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6458
6459 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6460 }
6461 }
6462
6463 {
6464 ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout,
6465 opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5,
6466 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6467 "BreakpointTable");
6468
6469 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6470 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6471 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6472 annotate_field (0);
6473 uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6474 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6475 annotate_field (1);
6476 uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6477 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6478 annotate_field (2);
6479 uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6480 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6481 annotate_field (3);
6482 uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6483 if (opts.addressprint)
6484 {
6485 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6486 annotate_field (4);
6487 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6488 uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6489 else
6490 uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6491 }
6492 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6493 annotate_field (5);
6494 uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6495 uiout->table_body ();
6496 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6497 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6498
6499 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6500 {
6501 QUIT;
6502 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6503 if (filter && !filter (b))
6504 continue;
6505
6506 /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6507 accept. Skip the others. */
6508
6509 if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0')
6510 {
6511 if (show_internal) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6512 {
6513 if (parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b->number)
6514 continue;
6515 }
6516 else /* all others */
6517 {
6518 if (!number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b->number))
6519 continue;
6520 }
6521 }
6522 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6523 show_internal is set. */
6524 if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6525 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, show_internal);
6526 }
6527 }
6528
6529 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6530 {
6531 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6532 empty list. */
6533 if (!filter)
6534 {
6535 if (bp_num_list == NULL || *bp_num_list == '\0')
6536 uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6537 else
6538 uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6539 bp_num_list);
6540 }
6541 }
6542 else
6543 {
6544 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6545 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6546 }
6547
6548 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6549 there have been breakpoints? */
6550 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6551
6552 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6553 }
6554
6555 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6556 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6557
6558 static void
6559 default_collect_info (void)
6560 {
6561 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6562
6563 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6564 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6565 not wanted. */
6566 if (!*default_collect)
6567 return;
6568
6569 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6570 actions. */
6571 uiout->text ("default collect ");
6572 uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect);
6573 uiout->text (" \n");
6574 }
6575
6576 static void
6577 info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6578 {
6579 breakpoint_1 (args, false, NULL);
6580
6581 default_collect_info ();
6582 }
6583
6584 static void
6585 info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6586 {
6587 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_watchpoint);
6588 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6589
6590 if (num_printed == 0)
6591 {
6592 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6593 uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n");
6594 else
6595 uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6596 }
6597 }
6598
6599 static void
6600 maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty)
6601 {
6602 breakpoint_1 (args, true, NULL);
6603
6604 default_collect_info ();
6605 }
6606
6607 static int
6608 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6609 struct program_space *pspace,
6610 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6611 {
6612 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
6613
6614 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
6615 {
6616 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6617 && bl->address == pc
6618 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6619 return 1;
6620 }
6621 return 0;
6622 }
6623
6624 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6625 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6626 address spaces. */
6627
6628 static void
6629 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6630 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6631 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6632 {
6633 int others = 0;
6634 struct breakpoint *b;
6635
6636 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6637 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6638 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6639 if (others > 0)
6640 {
6641 if (others == 1)
6642 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6643 else /* if (others == ???) */
6644 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6645 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6646 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6647 {
6648 others--;
6649 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6650 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6651 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6652 else if (b->thread != -1)
6653 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6654 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6655 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6656 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6657 ? " (disabled)"
6658 : ""),
6659 (others > 1) ? ","
6660 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6661 }
6662 current_uiout->message (_("also set at pc %ps.\n"),
6663 styled_string (address_style.style (),
6664 paddress (gdbarch, pc)));
6665 }
6666 }
6667 \f
6668
6669 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of LOC.
6670 For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members are
6671 irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to
6672 other addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6673
6674 More specifically, software watchpoints and catchpoints that are
6675 not backed by breakpoints always have a zero valued location
6676 address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of these types
6677 to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint location at address
6678 zero. */
6679
6680 static bool
6681 bl_address_is_meaningful (bp_location *loc)
6682 {
6683 return loc->loc_type != bp_loc_other;
6684 }
6685
6686 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6687 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6688
6689 static int
6690 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6691 struct bp_location *loc2)
6692 {
6693 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6694 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6695
6696 /* Both of them must exist. */
6697 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6698 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6699
6700 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6701 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6702 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6703 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6704 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6705 other watchpoint. */
6706 if ((w1->cond_exp
6707 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6708 loc1->length,
6709 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6710 w1->cond_exp.get ()))
6711 || (w2->cond_exp
6712 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6713 loc2->length,
6714 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6715 w2->cond_exp.get ())))
6716 return 0;
6717
6718 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6719 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6720 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6721 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6722 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6723 become hw_access locations later. */
6724 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6725 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6726 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6727 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6728 }
6729
6730 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6731
6732 int
6733 breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6734 const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6735 {
6736 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6737 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6738 && addr1 == addr2);
6739 }
6740
6741 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6742 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6743 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6744 space doesn't really matter. */
6745
6746 static int
6747 breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1,
6748 CORE_ADDR addr1,
6749 int len1, const address_space *aspace2,
6750 CORE_ADDR addr2)
6751 {
6752 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6753 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6754 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6755 }
6756
6757 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6758 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6759 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6760 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6761
6762 static int
6763 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6764 const address_space *aspace,
6765 CORE_ADDR addr)
6766 {
6767 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6768 aspace, addr)
6769 || (bl->length
6770 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6771 bl->address, bl->length,
6772 aspace, addr)));
6773 }
6774
6775 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
6776 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
6777 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
6778 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
6779 doesn't really matter. */
6780
6781 static int
6782 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
6783 const address_space *aspace,
6784 CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
6785 {
6786 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6787 || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
6788 {
6789 int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
6790
6791 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
6792 return 1;
6793 }
6794 return 0;
6795 }
6796
6797 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6798 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6799 true, otherwise returns false. */
6800
6801 static int
6802 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6803 struct bp_location *loc2)
6804 {
6805 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6806 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6807 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6808 different locations. */
6809 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6810 else
6811 return 0;
6812 }
6813
6814 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6815 (bl_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent
6816 the same location. */
6817
6818 static int
6819 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6820 struct bp_location *loc2)
6821 {
6822 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
6823
6824 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6825 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
6826 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
6827
6828 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
6829 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
6830
6831 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
6832 return 0;
6833 else if (hw_point1)
6834 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6835 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6836 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6837 else
6838 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
6839 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
6840 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
6841 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6842 }
6843
6844 static void
6845 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
6846 int bnum, int have_bnum)
6847 {
6848 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
6849 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
6850 char astr1[64];
6851 char astr2[64];
6852
6853 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
6854 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
6855 if (have_bnum)
6856 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
6857 bnum, astr1, astr2);
6858 else
6859 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
6860 }
6861
6862 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
6863 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
6864 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
6865 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
6866
6867 static CORE_ADDR
6868 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6869 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
6870 {
6871 if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
6872 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6873 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
6874 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
6875 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
6876 {
6877 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
6878 have their addresses modified. */
6879 return bpaddr;
6880 }
6881 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
6882 {
6883 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
6884 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
6885 applies to this address, then it should have already been
6886 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
6887 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
6888 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
6889 return bpaddr;
6890 }
6891 else
6892 {
6893 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr;
6894
6895 if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
6896 {
6897 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
6898 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
6899 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
6900 }
6901
6902 adjusted_bpaddr = address_significant (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr);
6903
6904 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
6905 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
6906 is required. */
6907 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
6908 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
6909
6910 return adjusted_bpaddr;
6911 }
6912 }
6913
6914 static bp_loc_type
6915 bp_location_from_bp_type (bptype type)
6916 {
6917 switch (type)
6918 {
6919 case bp_breakpoint:
6920 case bp_single_step:
6921 case bp_until:
6922 case bp_finish:
6923 case bp_longjmp:
6924 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6925 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6926 case bp_exception:
6927 case bp_exception_resume:
6928 case bp_step_resume:
6929 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6930 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6931 case bp_call_dummy:
6932 case bp_std_terminate:
6933 case bp_shlib_event:
6934 case bp_thread_event:
6935 case bp_overlay_event:
6936 case bp_jit_event:
6937 case bp_longjmp_master:
6938 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6939 case bp_exception_master:
6940 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6941 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6942 case bp_dprintf:
6943 return bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
6944 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6945 return bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
6946 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6947 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6948 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6949 return bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
6950 case bp_watchpoint:
6951 case bp_catchpoint:
6952 case bp_tracepoint:
6953 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6954 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6955 return bp_loc_other;
6956 default:
6957 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
6958 }
6959 }
6960
6961 bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner, bp_loc_type type)
6962 {
6963 this->owner = owner;
6964 this->cond_bytecode = NULL;
6965 this->shlib_disabled = 0;
6966 this->enabled = 1;
6967
6968 this->loc_type = type;
6969
6970 if (this->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
6971 || this->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
6972 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (this);
6973
6974 this->refc = 1;
6975 }
6976
6977 bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner)
6978 : bp_location::bp_location (owner,
6979 bp_location_from_bp_type (owner->type))
6980 {
6981 }
6982
6983 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
6984
6985 static struct bp_location *
6986 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6987 {
6988 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
6989 }
6990
6991 static void
6992 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
6993 {
6994 delete loc;
6995 }
6996
6997 /* Increment reference count. */
6998
6999 static void
7000 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7001 {
7002 ++bl->refc;
7003 }
7004
7005 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7006 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7007
7008 static void
7009 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7010 {
7011 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7012
7013 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7014 free_bp_location (*blp);
7015 *blp = NULL;
7016 }
7017
7018 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7019
7020 static breakpoint *
7021 add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b)
7022 {
7023 struct breakpoint *b1;
7024 struct breakpoint *result = b.get ();
7025
7026 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7027 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7028
7029 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7030 if (b1 == 0)
7031 breakpoint_chain = b.release ();
7032 else
7033 {
7034 while (b1->next)
7035 b1 = b1->next;
7036 b1->next = b.release ();
7037 }
7038
7039 return result;
7040 }
7041
7042 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7043
7044 static void
7045 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7046 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7047 enum bptype bptype,
7048 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7049 {
7050 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7051
7052 b->ops = ops;
7053 b->type = bptype;
7054 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7055 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7056 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7057 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7058 }
7059
7060 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7061 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7062
7063 static struct breakpoint *
7064 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7065 enum bptype bptype,
7066 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7067 {
7068 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7069
7070 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7071 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7072 }
7073
7074 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
7075
7076 static void
7077 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
7078 {
7079 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7080
7081 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7082 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7083 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7084 {
7085 const char *function_name;
7086
7087 if (loc->msymbol != NULL
7088 && (MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_text_gnu_ifunc
7089 || MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_data_gnu_ifunc))
7090 {
7091 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7092
7093 function_name = loc->msymbol->linkage_name ();
7094
7095 if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7096 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7097 {
7098 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7099 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7100 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7101 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7102 breakpoint. */
7103 loc->related_address = loc->address;
7104 }
7105 }
7106 else
7107 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &function_name, NULL, NULL);
7108
7109 if (function_name)
7110 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7111 }
7112 }
7113
7114 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7115 struct gdbarch *
7116 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7117 {
7118 if (sal.section)
7119 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7120 if (sal.symtab)
7121 return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab));
7122
7123 return NULL;
7124 }
7125
7126 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7127 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7128 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7129
7130 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7131 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7132 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7133
7134 static void
7135 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7136 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7137 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7138 {
7139 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7140
7141 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7142
7143 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7144 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7145
7146 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7147 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7148 program space. */
7149 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7150 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7151 }
7152
7153 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7154 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7155 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7156 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7157 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7158 is also returned as the value of this function.
7159
7160 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7161 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7162 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7163 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7164 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7165 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7166 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7167
7168 struct breakpoint *
7169 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7170 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7171 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7172 {
7173 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7174
7175 init_raw_breakpoint (b.get (), gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7176 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7177 }
7178
7179 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7180 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7181 initiated the operation. */
7182
7183 void
7184 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7185 {
7186 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7187 int thread = tp->global_num;
7188
7189 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7190 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7191 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7192 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7193 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7194 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7195 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7196 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7197 {
7198 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7199 struct breakpoint *clone;
7200
7201 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7202 after their removal. */
7203 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7204 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7205 clone->thread = thread;
7206 }
7207
7208 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7209 }
7210
7211 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7212 void
7213 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7214 {
7215 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7216
7217 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7218 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7219 {
7220 if (b->thread == thread)
7221 delete_breakpoint (b);
7222 }
7223 }
7224
7225 void
7226 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7227 {
7228 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7229
7230 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7231 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7232 {
7233 if (b->thread == thread)
7234 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7235 }
7236 }
7237
7238 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7239 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7240 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7241 breakpoints. */
7242
7243 struct breakpoint *
7244 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7245 {
7246 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7247
7248 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7249 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7250 {
7251 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7252
7253 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7254 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7255 1);
7256 new_b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
7257
7258 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7259
7260 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7261 if (retval == NULL)
7262 retval = new_b;
7263 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7264 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7265 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7266 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7267 }
7268
7269 return retval;
7270 }
7271
7272 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7273 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7274 stack.
7275
7276 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7277 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7278 frames. */
7279
7280 void
7281 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7282 {
7283 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7284
7285 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7286 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
7287 {
7288 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7289
7290 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7291 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7292 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7293 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7294 continue;
7295
7296 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp);
7297
7298 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7299 {
7300 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7301 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7302 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7303 }
7304 delete_breakpoint (b);
7305 }
7306 }
7307
7308 void
7309 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7310 {
7311 struct breakpoint *b;
7312
7313 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7314 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7315 {
7316 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7317 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7318 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7319 }
7320 }
7321
7322 void
7323 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7324 {
7325 struct breakpoint *b;
7326
7327 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7328 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7329 {
7330 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7331 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7332 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7333 }
7334 }
7335
7336 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7337 master breakpoint. */
7338 void
7339 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7340 {
7341 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7342
7343 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7344 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7345 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7346 {
7347 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7348 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7349 }
7350 }
7351
7352 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7353 void
7354 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7355 {
7356 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7357
7358 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7359 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7360 delete_breakpoint (b);
7361 }
7362
7363 struct breakpoint *
7364 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7365 {
7366 struct breakpoint *b;
7367
7368 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7369 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7370
7371 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7372 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7373 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
7374
7375 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7376
7377 return b;
7378 }
7379
7380 struct lang_and_radix
7381 {
7382 enum language lang;
7383 int radix;
7384 };
7385
7386 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7387
7388 struct breakpoint *
7389 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7390 {
7391 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7392 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7393 }
7394
7395 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7396
7397 void
7398 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7399 {
7400 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7401
7402 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7403 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7404 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7405 delete_breakpoint (b);
7406 }
7407
7408 void
7409 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7410 {
7411 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7412
7413 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7414 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7415 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7416 delete_breakpoint (b);
7417 }
7418
7419 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7420
7421 void
7422 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7423 {
7424 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7425
7426 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7427 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7428 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7429 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7430 }
7431
7432 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7433 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7434 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7435
7436 static struct breakpoint *
7437 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7438 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7439 {
7440 struct breakpoint *b;
7441
7442 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7443 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7444 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7445 return b;
7446 }
7447
7448 struct breakpoint *
7449 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7450 {
7451 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7452 }
7453
7454 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7455
7456 struct breakpoint *
7457 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7458 {
7459 struct breakpoint *b;
7460
7461 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7462 locations. */
7463 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7464 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7465 {
7466 delete_breakpoint (b);
7467 return NULL;
7468 }
7469 return b;
7470 }
7471
7472 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7473 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7474
7475 void
7476 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7477 {
7478 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7479
7480 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7481 {
7482 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7483 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7484
7485 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7486 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7487 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7488 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7489 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7490 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7491 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7492 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7493 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7494 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7495 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7496 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7497 )
7498 {
7499 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7500 }
7501 }
7502 }
7503
7504 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7505 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7506 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7507
7508 static void
7509 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7510 {
7511 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7512 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7513
7514 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7515 {
7516 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7517 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7518
7519 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7520 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7521 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7522 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7523 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7524 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7525 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7526 || is_tracepoint (b))
7527 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7528 {
7529 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7530 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7531 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7532 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7533 loc->inserted = 0;
7534
7535 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7536 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7537
7538 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7539 {
7540 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
7541 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7542 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7543 solib->so_name);
7544 }
7545 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7546 }
7547 }
7548 }
7549
7550 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7551 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7552 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7553
7554 static void
7555 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7556 {
7557 struct breakpoint *b;
7558
7559 if (objfile == NULL)
7560 return;
7561
7562 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7563 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7564 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7565 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7566 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7567 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7568 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7569 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7570 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7571 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7572 main objfile). */
7573 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7574 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7575 return;
7576
7577 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7578 {
7579 struct bp_location *loc;
7580 int bp_modified = 0;
7581
7582 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7583 continue;
7584
7585 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
7586 {
7587 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7588
7589 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7590 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7591 continue;
7592
7593 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7594 continue;
7595
7596 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7597 continue;
7598
7599 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7600 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7601 continue;
7602
7603 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7604 {
7605 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7606 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7607 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7608 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7609 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7610 unmapped. */
7611
7612 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7613
7614 bp_modified = 1;
7615 }
7616 }
7617
7618 if (bp_modified)
7619 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7620 }
7621 }
7622
7623 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7624
7625 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7626 catchpoint. A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points
7627 to CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7628
7629 struct fork_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7630 {
7631 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7632 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7633 catchpoint has triggered. */
7634 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7635 };
7636
7637 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7638 catchpoints. */
7639
7640 static int
7641 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7642 {
7643 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7644 }
7645
7646 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7647 catchpoints. */
7648
7649 static int
7650 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7651 {
7652 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7653 }
7654
7655 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7656 catchpoints. */
7657
7658 static int
7659 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7660 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7661 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7662 {
7663 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7664
7665 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7666 return 0;
7667
7668 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7669 return 1;
7670 }
7671
7672 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7673 catchpoints. */
7674
7675 static enum print_stop_action
7676 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
7677 {
7678 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7679 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7680 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7681
7682 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7683 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7684 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7685 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7686 else
7687 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7688 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7689 {
7690 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
7691 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7692 }
7693 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
7694 uiout->text (" (forked process ");
7695 uiout->field_signed ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7696 uiout->text ("), ");
7697 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7698 }
7699
7700 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7701 catchpoints. */
7702
7703 static void
7704 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7705 {
7706 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7707 struct value_print_options opts;
7708 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7709
7710 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7711
7712 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7713 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7714 readable). */
7715 if (opts.addressprint)
7716 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7717 annotate_field (5);
7718 uiout->text ("fork");
7719 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7720 {
7721 uiout->text (", process ");
7722 uiout->field_signed ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7723 uiout->spaces (1);
7724 }
7725
7726 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7727 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "fork");
7728 }
7729
7730 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7731 catchpoints. */
7732
7733 static void
7734 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
7735 {
7736 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
7737 }
7738
7739 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7740 catchpoints. */
7741
7742 static void
7743 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7744 {
7745 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
7746 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7747 }
7748
7749 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7750
7751 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
7752
7753 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7754 catchpoints. */
7755
7756 static int
7757 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7758 {
7759 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7760 }
7761
7762 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7763 catchpoints. */
7764
7765 static int
7766 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7767 {
7768 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7769 }
7770
7771 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7772 catchpoints. */
7773
7774 static int
7775 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7776 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7777 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7778 {
7779 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7780
7781 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
7782 return 0;
7783
7784 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7785 return 1;
7786 }
7787
7788 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7789 catchpoints. */
7790
7791 static enum print_stop_action
7792 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
7793 {
7794 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7795 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7796 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7797
7798 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7799 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7800 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7801 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7802 else
7803 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7804 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7805 {
7806 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
7807 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7808 }
7809 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
7810 uiout->text (" (vforked process ");
7811 uiout->field_signed ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7812 uiout->text ("), ");
7813 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7814 }
7815
7816 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7817 catchpoints. */
7818
7819 static void
7820 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7821 {
7822 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7823 struct value_print_options opts;
7824 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7825
7826 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7827 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7828 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7829 readable). */
7830 if (opts.addressprint)
7831 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7832 annotate_field (5);
7833 uiout->text ("vfork");
7834 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7835 {
7836 uiout->text (", process ");
7837 uiout->field_signed ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7838 uiout->spaces (1);
7839 }
7840
7841 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7842 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "vfork");
7843 }
7844
7845 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7846 catchpoints. */
7847
7848 static void
7849 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
7850 {
7851 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
7852 }
7853
7854 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7855 catchpoints. */
7856
7857 static void
7858 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7859 {
7860 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
7861 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7862 }
7863
7864 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
7865
7866 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
7867
7868 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
7869 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7870 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7871
7872 struct solib_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7873 {
7874 ~solib_catchpoint () override;
7875
7876 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
7877 unsigned char is_load;
7878
7879 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
7880 REGEX is non-NULL. */
7881 char *regex;
7882 std::unique_ptr<compiled_regex> compiled;
7883 };
7884
7885 solib_catchpoint::~solib_catchpoint ()
7886 {
7887 xfree (this->regex);
7888 }
7889
7890 static int
7891 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
7892 {
7893 return 0;
7894 }
7895
7896 static int
7897 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7898 {
7899 return 0;
7900 }
7901
7902 static int
7903 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
7904 const address_space *aspace,
7905 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7906 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7907 {
7908 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7909 struct breakpoint *other;
7910
7911 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
7912 return 1;
7913
7914 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
7915 {
7916 struct bp_location *other_bl;
7917
7918 if (other == bl->owner)
7919 continue;
7920
7921 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
7922 continue;
7923
7924 if (self->pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->pspace)
7925 continue;
7926
7927 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
7928 {
7929 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
7930 return 1;
7931 }
7932 }
7933
7934 return 0;
7935 }
7936
7937 static void
7938 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
7939 {
7940 struct solib_catchpoint *self
7941 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7942
7943 if (self->is_load)
7944 {
7945 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
7946 {
7947 if (!self->regex
7948 || self->compiled->exec (iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
7949 return;
7950 }
7951 }
7952 else
7953 {
7954 for (const std::string &iter : current_program_space->deleted_solibs)
7955 {
7956 if (!self->regex
7957 || self->compiled->exec (iter.c_str (), 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
7958 return;
7959 }
7960 }
7961
7962 bs->stop = 0;
7963 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
7964 }
7965
7966 static enum print_stop_action
7967 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
7968 {
7969 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7970 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7971
7972 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7973 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7974 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7975 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7976 else
7977 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7978 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
7979 uiout->text ("\n");
7980 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7981 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7982 print_solib_event (1);
7983 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7984 }
7985
7986 static void
7987 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
7988 {
7989 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
7990 struct value_print_options opts;
7991 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7992
7993 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7994 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7995 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7996 readable). */
7997 if (opts.addressprint)
7998 {
7999 annotate_field (4);
8000 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8001 }
8002
8003 std::string msg;
8004 annotate_field (5);
8005 if (self->is_load)
8006 {
8007 if (self->regex)
8008 msg = string_printf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8009 else
8010 msg = _("load of library");
8011 }
8012 else
8013 {
8014 if (self->regex)
8015 msg = string_printf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8016 else
8017 msg = _("unload of library");
8018 }
8019 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
8020
8021 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8022 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8023 }
8024
8025 static void
8026 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8027 {
8028 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8029
8030 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8031 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8032 }
8033
8034 static void
8035 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8036 {
8037 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8038
8039 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8040 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8041 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8042 if (self->regex)
8043 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8044 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8045 }
8046
8047 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8048
8049 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8050 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8051 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8052 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8053 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8054 created in an enabled state. */
8055
8056 void
8057 add_solib_catchpoint (const char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8058 {
8059 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8060
8061 if (!arg)
8062 arg = "";
8063 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8064
8065 std::unique_ptr<solib_catchpoint> c (new solib_catchpoint ());
8066
8067 if (*arg != '\0')
8068 {
8069 c->compiled.reset (new compiled_regex (arg, REG_NOSUB,
8070 _("Invalid regexp")));
8071 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8072 }
8073
8074 c->is_load = is_load;
8075 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8076 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8077
8078 c->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8079
8080 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8081 }
8082
8083 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8084 "catch unload". */
8085
8086 static void
8087 catch_load_or_unload (const char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8088 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8089 {
8090 int tempflag;
8091 const int enabled = 1;
8092
8093 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8094
8095 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8096 }
8097
8098 static void
8099 catch_load_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8100 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8101 {
8102 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8103 }
8104
8105 static void
8106 catch_unload_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8107 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8108 {
8109 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8110 }
8111
8112 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8113 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8114 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8115 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8116
8117 void
8118 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8119 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8120 const char *cond_string,
8121 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8122 {
8123 symtab_and_line sal;
8124 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8125
8126 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8127
8128 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8129 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8130 }
8131
8132 void
8133 install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll)
8134 {
8135 breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg));
8136 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8137 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8138 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8139 if (!internal)
8140 mention (b);
8141 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
8142
8143 if (update_gll)
8144 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8145 }
8146
8147 static void
8148 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8149 int tempflag, const char *cond_string,
8150 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8151 {
8152 std::unique_ptr<fork_catchpoint> c (new fork_catchpoint ());
8153
8154 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8155
8156 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8157
8158 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8159 }
8160
8161 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8162
8163 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8164 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8165 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8166
8167 struct exec_catchpoint : public breakpoint
8168 {
8169 ~exec_catchpoint () override;
8170
8171 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8172 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8173 triggered. */
8174 char *exec_pathname;
8175 };
8176
8177 /* Exec catchpoint destructor. */
8178
8179 exec_catchpoint::~exec_catchpoint ()
8180 {
8181 xfree (this->exec_pathname);
8182 }
8183
8184 static int
8185 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8186 {
8187 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8188 }
8189
8190 static int
8191 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8192 {
8193 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8194 }
8195
8196 static int
8197 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8198 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8199 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8200 {
8201 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8202
8203 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8204 return 0;
8205
8206 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8207 return 1;
8208 }
8209
8210 static enum print_stop_action
8211 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8212 {
8213 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8214 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8215 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8216
8217 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8218 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8219 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8220 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8221 else
8222 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8223 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8224 {
8225 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8226 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8227 }
8228 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
8229 uiout->text (" (exec'd ");
8230 uiout->field_string ("new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8231 uiout->text ("), ");
8232
8233 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8234 }
8235
8236 static void
8237 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8238 {
8239 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8240 struct value_print_options opts;
8241 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8242
8243 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8244
8245 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8246 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8247 is relatively readable). */
8248 if (opts.addressprint)
8249 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8250 annotate_field (5);
8251 uiout->text ("exec");
8252 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8253 {
8254 uiout->text (", program \"");
8255 uiout->field_string ("what", c->exec_pathname);
8256 uiout->text ("\" ");
8257 }
8258
8259 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8260 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "exec");
8261 }
8262
8263 static void
8264 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8265 {
8266 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8267 }
8268
8269 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8270 catchpoints. */
8271
8272 static void
8273 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8274 {
8275 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8276 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8277 }
8278
8279 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8280
8281 static int
8282 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8283 {
8284 int i = 0;
8285 struct breakpoint *b;
8286 struct bp_location *bl;
8287
8288 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8289 {
8290 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8291 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8292 {
8293 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8294 one register. */
8295 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8296 }
8297 }
8298
8299 return i;
8300 }
8301
8302 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8303 watchpoint. */
8304
8305 static int
8306 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8307 {
8308 int i = 0;
8309 struct bp_location *bl;
8310
8311 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8312 return 0;
8313
8314 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8315 {
8316 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8317 one register. */
8318 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8319 }
8320
8321 return i;
8322 }
8323
8324 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8325 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8326 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8327 types _not_ TYPE. */
8328
8329 static int
8330 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8331 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8332 {
8333 int i = 0;
8334 struct breakpoint *b;
8335
8336 *other_type_used = 0;
8337 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8338 {
8339 if (b == except)
8340 continue;
8341 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8342 continue;
8343
8344 if (b->type == type)
8345 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8346 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8347 *other_type_used = 1;
8348 }
8349
8350 return i;
8351 }
8352
8353 void
8354 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8355 {
8356 struct breakpoint *b;
8357
8358 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8359 {
8360 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8361 {
8362 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8363 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8364 }
8365 }
8366 }
8367
8368 void
8369 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8370 {
8371 struct breakpoint *b;
8372
8373 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8374 {
8375 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8376 {
8377 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8378 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8379 }
8380 }
8381 }
8382
8383 void
8384 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8385 {
8386 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8387 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8388 }
8389
8390 void
8391 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8392 {
8393 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8394 breakpoint_re_set ();
8395 }
8396
8397 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8398 locations. */
8399
8400 static struct breakpoint *
8401 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8402 {
8403 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b (new breakpoint ());
8404
8405 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8406 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8407
8408 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8409 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8410
8411 b->thread = thread;
8412 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8413
8414 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
8415 }
8416
8417 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8418 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8419 frame. */
8420
8421 breakpoint_up
8422 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8423 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8424 {
8425 struct breakpoint *b;
8426
8427 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8428 tail-called one. */
8429 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8430
8431 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8432 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8433 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8434 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8435
8436 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
8437
8438 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8439
8440 return breakpoint_up (b);
8441 }
8442
8443 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8444 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8445 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8446
8447 static struct breakpoint *
8448 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8449 enum bptype type,
8450 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8451 int loc_enabled)
8452 {
8453 struct breakpoint *copy;
8454
8455 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8456 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8457 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
8458
8459 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8460 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8461 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8462 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8463 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8464 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8465 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8466 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8467 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8468 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8469 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8470 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8471
8472 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8473 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8474 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8475
8476 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8477 return copy;
8478 }
8479
8480 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8481 ORIG is NULL. */
8482
8483 struct breakpoint *
8484 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8485 {
8486 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8487 if (orig == NULL)
8488 return NULL;
8489
8490 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
8491 }
8492
8493 breakpoint_up
8494 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8495 enum bptype type)
8496 {
8497 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8498
8499 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8500 sal.pc = pc;
8501 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8502 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8503
8504 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8505 }
8506 \f
8507
8508 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8509
8510 static void
8511 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8512 {
8513 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8514 current_uiout->text ("\n");
8515 }
8516 \f
8517
8518 static bool bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
8519
8520 static struct bp_location *
8521 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8522 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8523 {
8524 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8525 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8526 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8527
8528 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8529 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8530
8531 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8532 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8533 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8534 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8535 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8536 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8537 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8538 sal->pc, b->type);
8539
8540 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8541 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8542 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
8543 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8544 ;
8545 loc->next = *tmp;
8546 *tmp = loc;
8547
8548 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8549 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8550 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8551 loc->probe.prob = sal->prob;
8552 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
8553 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8554 loc->section = sal->section;
8555 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8556 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8557 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
8558 loc->symbol = sal->symbol;
8559 loc->msymbol = sal->msymbol;
8560 loc->objfile = sal->objfile;
8561
8562 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
8563
8564 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8565 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8566 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8567 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8568 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8569 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8570 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8571 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8572 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8573 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8574 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8575 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8576 instruction.) */
8577 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8578 loc->permanent = 1;
8579
8580 return loc;
8581 }
8582 \f
8583
8584 /* Return true if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
8585 return false otherwise. */
8586
8587 static bool
8588 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
8589 {
8590 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
8591
8592 /* If we have a non-breakpoint-backed catchpoint or a software
8593 watchpoint, just return 0. We should not attempt to read from
8594 the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types point to.
8595 gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
8596 memory. */
8597 if (!bl_address_is_meaningful (loc))
8598 return false;
8599
8600 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
8601 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
8602 return gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
8603 }
8604
8605 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
8606 settings of the dprintf style options. */
8607
8608 static void
8609 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
8610 {
8611 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
8612 char *printf_line = NULL;
8613
8614 if (!dprintf_args)
8615 return;
8616
8617 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8618
8619 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
8620 insist on it. */
8621 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
8622 ++dprintf_args;
8623 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8624
8625 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
8626 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
8627
8628 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
8629 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8630 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
8631 {
8632 if (!dprintf_function)
8633 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
8634
8635 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
8636 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
8637 dprintf_function,
8638 dprintf_channel,
8639 dprintf_args);
8640 else
8641 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
8642 dprintf_function,
8643 dprintf_args);
8644 }
8645 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
8646 {
8647 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
8648 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
8649 else
8650 {
8651 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
8652 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8653 }
8654 }
8655 else
8656 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8657 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
8658
8659 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
8660
8661 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
8662 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line
8663 = new struct command_line (simple_control, printf_line);
8664 breakpoint_set_commands (b, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line,
8665 command_lines_deleter ()));
8666 }
8667
8668 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
8669 current style settings. */
8670
8671 static void
8672 update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty,
8673 struct cmd_list_element *c)
8674 {
8675 struct breakpoint *b;
8676
8677 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8678 {
8679 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
8680 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8681 }
8682 }
8683
8684 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
8685 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
8686 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
8687 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
8688
8689 static void
8690 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8691 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8692 event_location_up &&location,
8693 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8694 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8695 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8696 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8697 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8698 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8699 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8700 int display_canonical)
8701 {
8702 int i;
8703
8704 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
8705 {
8706 int target_resources_ok;
8707
8708 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
8709 target_resources_ok =
8710 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
8711 i + 1, 0);
8712 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
8713 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
8714 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
8715 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
8716 }
8717
8718 gdb_assert (!sals.empty ());
8719
8720 for (const auto &sal : sals)
8721 {
8722 struct bp_location *loc;
8723
8724 if (from_tty)
8725 {
8726 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8727 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8728 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8729
8730 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8731 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
8732 }
8733
8734 if (&sal == &sals[0])
8735 {
8736 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
8737 b->thread = thread;
8738 b->task = task;
8739
8740 b->cond_string = cond_string.release ();
8741 b->extra_string = extra_string.release ();
8742 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
8743 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8744 b->disposition = disposition;
8745
8746 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8747 b->loc->inserted = 1;
8748
8749 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
8750 {
8751 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
8752 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
8753
8754 if (strace_marker_p (b))
8755 {
8756 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
8757 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
8758 const char *p
8759 = &event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())[3];
8760 const char *endp;
8761
8762 p = skip_spaces (p);
8763
8764 endp = skip_to_space (p);
8765
8766 t->static_trace_marker_id.assign (p, endp - p);
8767
8768 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8769 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8770 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8771 }
8772 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
8773 {
8774 t->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
8775
8776 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8777 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8778 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8779 }
8780 else
8781 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
8782 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
8783 }
8784
8785 loc = b->loc;
8786 }
8787 else
8788 {
8789 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
8790 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8791 loc->inserted = 1;
8792 }
8793
8794 if (b->cond_string)
8795 {
8796 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
8797
8798 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
8799 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
8800 if (*arg)
8801 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
8802 }
8803
8804 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
8805 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
8806 if (type == bp_dprintf)
8807 {
8808 if (b->extra_string)
8809 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8810 else
8811 error (_("Format string required"));
8812 }
8813 else if (b->extra_string)
8814 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
8815 }
8816
8817 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
8818 if (location != NULL)
8819 b->location = std::move (location);
8820 else
8821 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
8822 b->filter = std::move (filter);
8823 }
8824
8825 static void
8826 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8827 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8828 event_location_up &&location,
8829 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8830 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8831 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8832 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8833 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8834 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8835 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8836 int display_canonical)
8837 {
8838 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type);
8839
8840 init_breakpoint_sal (b.get (), gdbarch,
8841 sals, std::move (location),
8842 std::move (filter),
8843 std::move (cond_string),
8844 std::move (extra_string),
8845 type, disposition,
8846 thread, task, ignore_count,
8847 ops, from_tty,
8848 enabled, internal, flags,
8849 display_canonical);
8850
8851 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
8852 }
8853
8854 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
8855 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
8856 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
8857 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
8858 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
8859 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
8860 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
8861 we take just a single condition string.
8862
8863 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
8864 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
8865 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
8866 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
8867 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
8868
8869 static void
8870 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8871 struct linespec_result *canonical,
8872 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8873 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8874 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8875 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8876 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8877 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
8878 {
8879 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
8880 gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1);
8881
8882 for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals)
8883 {
8884 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
8885 'break', without arguments. */
8886 event_location_up location
8887 = (canonical->location != NULL
8888 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()) : NULL);
8889 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string
8890 (lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL);
8891
8892 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals,
8893 std::move (location),
8894 std::move (filter_string),
8895 std::move (cond_string),
8896 std::move (extra_string),
8897 type, disposition,
8898 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
8899 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
8900 canonical->special_display);
8901 }
8902 }
8903
8904 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
8905 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
8906 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
8907 linespec locations).
8908
8909 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
8910 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
8911
8912 static void
8913 parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location,
8914 struct linespec_result *canonical)
8915 {
8916 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
8917
8918 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
8919 {
8920 const char *spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
8921
8922 if (spec == NULL)
8923 {
8924 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
8925 breakpoint address. */
8926 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
8927 {
8928 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
8929 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
8930 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
8931 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
8932 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
8933 symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
8934 CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc;
8935
8936 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8937
8938 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
8939 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
8940 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
8941 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
8942 instances with the same symtab and line. */
8943 sal.pc = pc;
8944 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8945
8946 struct linespec_sals lsal;
8947 lsal.sals = {sal};
8948 lsal.canonical = NULL;
8949
8950 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
8951 return;
8952 }
8953 else
8954 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
8955 }
8956 }
8957
8958 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
8959 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
8960 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
8961 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
8962
8963 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
8964 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
8965 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
8966 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
8967 {
8968 const char *spec = NULL;
8969
8970 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
8971 spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
8972
8973 if (!cursal.symtab
8974 || (spec != NULL
8975 && strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL
8976 && spec[1] != '['))
8977 {
8978 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
8979 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
8980 get_last_displayed_line (),
8981 canonical, NULL, NULL);
8982 return;
8983 }
8984 }
8985
8986 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
8987 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
8988 }
8989
8990
8991 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
8992 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
8993
8994 static void
8995 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals)
8996 {
8997 for (auto &sal : sals)
8998 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
8999 }
9000
9001 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9002 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9003 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9004 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9005 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9006 it, etc. */
9007
9008 static void
9009 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9010 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals)
9011 {
9012 for (const auto &sal : sals)
9013 {
9014 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9015
9016 sarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9017 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9018 associated with SAL. */
9019 if (sarch == NULL)
9020 sarch = gdbarch;
9021 std::string msg;
9022 if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg))
9023 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
9024 paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ());
9025 }
9026 }
9027
9028 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9029 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9030 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9031 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9032 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9033 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9034
9035 static void
9036 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9037 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9038 char **rest)
9039 {
9040 *cond_string = NULL;
9041 *thread = -1;
9042 *task = 0;
9043 *rest = NULL;
9044
9045 while (tok && *tok)
9046 {
9047 const char *end_tok;
9048 int toklen;
9049 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9050 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9051
9052 tok = skip_spaces (tok);
9053
9054 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9055 {
9056 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9057 return;
9058 }
9059
9060 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
9061
9062 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9063
9064 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9065 {
9066 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9067 parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9068 cond_end = tok;
9069 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9070 }
9071 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9072 {
9073 const char *tmptok;
9074 struct thread_info *thr;
9075
9076 tok = end_tok + 1;
9077 thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
9078 if (tok == tmptok)
9079 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9080 *thread = thr->global_num;
9081 tok = tmptok;
9082 }
9083 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9084 {
9085 char *tmptok;
9086
9087 tok = end_tok + 1;
9088 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9089 if (tok == tmptok)
9090 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9091 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9092 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9093 tok = tmptok;
9094 }
9095 else if (rest)
9096 {
9097 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9098 return;
9099 }
9100 else
9101 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9102 }
9103 }
9104
9105 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9106
9107 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
9108 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9109 {
9110 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9111 const char *endp;
9112
9113 p = skip_spaces (p);
9114
9115 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9116
9117 std::string marker_str (p, endp - p);
9118
9119 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
9120 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ());
9121 if (markers.empty ())
9122 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"),
9123 marker_str.c_str ());
9124
9125 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
9126 sals.reserve (markers.size ());
9127
9128 for (const static_tracepoint_marker &marker : markers)
9129 {
9130 symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker.address, 0);
9131 sal.pc = marker.address;
9132 sals.push_back (sal);
9133 }
9134
9135 *arg_p = endp;
9136 return sals;
9137 }
9138
9139 /* Returns the breakpoint ops appropriate for use with with LOCATION_TYPE and
9140 according to IS_TRACEPOINT. */
9141
9142 static const struct breakpoint_ops *
9143 breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type (enum event_location_type location_type,
9144 bool is_tracepoint)
9145 {
9146 if (is_tracepoint)
9147 {
9148 if (location_type == PROBE_LOCATION)
9149 return &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9150 else
9151 return &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
9152 }
9153 else
9154 {
9155 if (location_type == PROBE_LOCATION)
9156 return &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9157 else
9158 return &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9159 }
9160 }
9161
9162 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9163
9164 const struct breakpoint_ops *
9165 breakpoint_ops_for_event_location (const struct event_location *location,
9166 bool is_tracepoint)
9167 {
9168 if (location != nullptr)
9169 return breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type
9170 (event_location_type (location), is_tracepoint);
9171 return is_tracepoint ? &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops : &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9172 }
9173
9174 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9175
9176 int
9177 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9178 const struct event_location *location,
9179 const char *cond_string,
9180 int thread, const char *extra_string,
9181 int parse_extra,
9182 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9183 int ignore_count,
9184 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9185 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9186 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9187 unsigned flags)
9188 {
9189 struct linespec_result canonical;
9190 int pending = 0;
9191 int task = 0;
9192 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9193
9194 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9195
9196 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9197 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9198 extra_string = NULL;
9199
9200 try
9201 {
9202 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9203 }
9204 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
9205 {
9206 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9207 value. */
9208 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9209 {
9210 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9211 error. */
9212
9213 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9214 throw;
9215
9216 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9217
9218 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9219 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9220 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9221 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9222 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9223 return 0;
9224
9225 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9226 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9227 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9228 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9229 pending = 1;
9230 }
9231 else
9232 throw;
9233 }
9234
9235 if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ())
9236 return 0;
9237
9238 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9239 are ok for the target. */
9240 if (!pending)
9241 {
9242 for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9243 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals);
9244 }
9245
9246 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9247 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9248 {
9249 for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9250 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals);
9251 }
9252
9253 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9254 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9255 breakpoint. */
9256 if (!pending)
9257 {
9258 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy;
9259 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy;
9260
9261 if (parse_extra)
9262 {
9263 char *rest;
9264 char *cond;
9265
9266 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9267
9268 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9269 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9270 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9271 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9272
9273 find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal.sals[0].pc,
9274 &cond, &thread, &task, &rest);
9275 cond_string_copy.reset (cond);
9276 extra_string_copy.reset (rest);
9277 }
9278 else
9279 {
9280 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9281 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9282 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9283
9284 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9285 if (cond_string)
9286 cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string));
9287 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9288 if (extra_string)
9289 extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string));
9290 }
9291
9292 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9293 std::move (cond_string_copy),
9294 std::move (extra_string_copy),
9295 type_wanted,
9296 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9297 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9298 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9299 }
9300 else
9301 {
9302 std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type_wanted);
9303
9304 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9305 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9306
9307 if (parse_extra)
9308 b->cond_string = NULL;
9309 else
9310 {
9311 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9312 b->cond_string = cond_string != NULL ? xstrdup (cond_string) : NULL;
9313 b->thread = thread;
9314 }
9315
9316 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9317 b->extra_string = extra_string != NULL ? xstrdup (extra_string) : NULL;
9318 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9319 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9320 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9321 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9322 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9323 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9324 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9325
9326 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9327 }
9328
9329 if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1)
9330 {
9331 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9332 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9333 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9334 }
9335
9336 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9337
9338 return 1;
9339 }
9340
9341 /* Set a breakpoint.
9342 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9343 condition, and thread.
9344 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9345 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9346 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9347
9348 static void
9349 break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9350 {
9351 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9352 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9353 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9354 : bp_breakpoint);
9355
9356 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9357 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_event_location
9358 (location.get (), false /* is_tracepoint */);
9359
9360 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9361 location.get (),
9362 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9363 tempflag, type_wanted,
9364 0 /* Ignore count */,
9365 pending_break_support,
9366 ops,
9367 from_tty,
9368 1 /* enabled */,
9369 0 /* internal */,
9370 0);
9371 }
9372
9373 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9374
9375 void
9376 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9377 {
9378 CORE_ADDR pc;
9379
9380 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9381 {
9382 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9383 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9384 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
9385 sal->pc = pc;
9386
9387 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9388 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9389 if (sal->explicit_line)
9390 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9391 }
9392
9393 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9394 {
9395 const struct blockvector *bv;
9396 const struct block *b;
9397 struct symbol *sym;
9398
9399 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
9400 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
9401 if (bv != NULL)
9402 {
9403 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9404 if (sym != NULL)
9405 {
9406 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9407 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
9408 sym);
9409 }
9410 else
9411 {
9412 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9413 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9414 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9415 happen in assembly source). */
9416
9417 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
9418 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9419
9420 bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9421 if (msym.minsym)
9422 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
9423 }
9424 }
9425 }
9426 }
9427
9428 void
9429 break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9430 {
9431 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9432 }
9433
9434 void
9435 tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9436 {
9437 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9438 }
9439
9440 static void
9441 hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9442 {
9443 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9444 }
9445
9446 static void
9447 thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9448 {
9449 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9450 }
9451
9452 static void
9453 stop_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9454 {
9455 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9456 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9457 stop at <line>\n"));
9458 }
9459
9460 static void
9461 stopin_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9462 {
9463 int badInput = 0;
9464
9465 if (arg == NULL)
9466 badInput = 1;
9467 else if (*arg != '*')
9468 {
9469 const char *argptr = arg;
9470 int hasColon = 0;
9471
9472 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9473 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9474 function/method name. */
9475 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9476 {
9477 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9478 argptr++;
9479 }
9480
9481 if (hasColon)
9482 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
9483 else
9484 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
9485 }
9486
9487 if (badInput)
9488 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
9489 else
9490 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9491 }
9492
9493 static void
9494 stopat_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9495 {
9496 int badInput = 0;
9497
9498 if (arg == NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
9499 badInput = 1;
9500 else
9501 {
9502 const char *argptr = arg;
9503 int hasColon = 0;
9504
9505 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
9506 it is probably a line number. */
9507 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9508 {
9509 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9510 argptr++;
9511 }
9512
9513 if (hasColon)
9514 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
9515 else
9516 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
9517 }
9518
9519 if (badInput)
9520 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at LINE\n"));
9521 else
9522 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9523 }
9524
9525 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
9526 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
9527 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
9528 line. */
9529
9530 static void
9531 dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9532 {
9533 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9534
9535 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
9536 the next character must be ','. */
9537 if (arg != NULL)
9538 {
9539 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
9540 error (_("Format string required"));
9541 else
9542 {
9543 /* Skip the comma. */
9544 ++arg;
9545 }
9546 }
9547
9548 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9549 location.get (),
9550 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9551 0, bp_dprintf,
9552 0 /* Ignore count */,
9553 pending_break_support,
9554 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
9555 from_tty,
9556 1 /* enabled */,
9557 0 /* internal */,
9558 0);
9559 }
9560
9561 static void
9562 agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9563 {
9564 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
9565 }
9566
9567 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
9568 ranged breakpoints. */
9569
9570 static int
9571 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
9572 const address_space *aspace,
9573 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
9574 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
9575 {
9576 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
9577 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
9578 return 0;
9579
9580 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
9581 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
9582 }
9583
9584 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9585 ranged breakpoints. */
9586
9587 static int
9588 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9589 {
9590 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9591 }
9592
9593 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9594 ranged breakpoints. */
9595
9596 static enum print_stop_action
9597 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
9598 {
9599 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9600 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9601 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9602
9603 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9604
9605 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9606 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9607
9608 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
9609
9610 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
9611
9612 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
9613 uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
9614 else
9615 uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint ");
9616 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9617 {
9618 uiout->field_string ("reason",
9619 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
9620 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
9621 }
9622 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
9623 uiout->text (", ");
9624
9625 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
9626 }
9627
9628 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
9629 ranged breakpoints. */
9630
9631 static void
9632 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9633 struct bp_location **last_loc)
9634 {
9635 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9636 struct value_print_options opts;
9637 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9638
9639 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9640 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9641
9642 get_user_print_options (&opts);
9643
9644 if (opts.addressprint)
9645 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
9646 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
9647 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
9648 annotate_field (5);
9649 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
9650 *last_loc = bl;
9651 }
9652
9653 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
9654 ranged breakpoints. */
9655
9656 static void
9657 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
9658 struct ui_out *uiout)
9659 {
9660 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
9661 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9662 string_file stb;
9663
9664 gdb_assert (bl);
9665
9666 address_start = bl->address;
9667 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
9668
9669 uiout->text ("\taddress range: ");
9670 stb.printf ("[%s, %s]",
9671 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
9672 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
9673 uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb);
9674 uiout->text ("\n");
9675 }
9676
9677 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
9678 ranged breakpoints. */
9679
9680 static void
9681 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9682 {
9683 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9684 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9685
9686 gdb_assert (bl);
9687 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9688
9689 uiout->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
9690 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
9691 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
9692 }
9693
9694 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9695 ranged breakpoints. */
9696
9697 static void
9698 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
9699 {
9700 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
9701 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
9702 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end.get ()));
9703 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
9704 }
9705
9706 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
9707
9708 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
9709
9710 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
9711 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
9712 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
9713 last instruction of the given line. */
9714
9715 static CORE_ADDR
9716 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
9717 {
9718 CORE_ADDR end;
9719
9720 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
9721 find the address of the end of the given location. */
9722 if (sal.explicit_pc)
9723 end = sal.pc;
9724 else
9725 {
9726 int ret;
9727 CORE_ADDR start;
9728
9729 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
9730 if (!ret)
9731 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9732
9733 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
9734 end--;
9735 }
9736
9737 return end;
9738 }
9739
9740 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
9741
9742 static void
9743 break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9744 {
9745 const char *arg_start;
9746 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
9747 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
9748 CORE_ADDR end;
9749 struct breakpoint *b;
9750
9751 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
9752 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
9753 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
9754
9755 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9756 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9757 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9758 bp_count, 0);
9759 if (can_use_bp < 0)
9760 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9761
9762 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9763 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
9764 error(_("No address range specified."));
9765
9766 arg_start = arg;
9767 event_location_up start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9768 current_language);
9769 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location.get (), &canonical_start);
9770
9771 if (arg[0] != ',')
9772 error (_("Too few arguments."));
9773 else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ())
9774 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
9775
9776 const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0];
9777
9778 if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1
9779 || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1)
9780 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9781
9782 const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0];
9783 std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
9784
9785 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
9786 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9787
9788 /* Parse the end location. */
9789
9790 arg_start = arg;
9791
9792 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
9793 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
9794 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
9795 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
9796 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
9797 event_location_up end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9798 current_language);
9799 decode_line_full (end_location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9800 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
9801 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
9802
9803 if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ())
9804 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9805
9806 const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0];
9807 if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1
9808 || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1)
9809 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9810
9811 const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0];
9812
9813 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
9814 if (sal_start.pc > end)
9815 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
9816
9817 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
9818 if (length < 0)
9819 /* Length overflowed. */
9820 error (_("Address range too large."));
9821 else if (length == 1)
9822 {
9823 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
9824 the `hbreak' command. */
9825 hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1);
9826
9827 return;
9828 }
9829
9830 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
9831 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
9832 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
9833 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
9834 b->number = breakpoint_count;
9835 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9836 b->location = std::move (start_location);
9837 b->location_range_end = std::move (end_location);
9838 b->loc->length = length;
9839
9840 mention (b);
9841 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
9842 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9843 }
9844
9845 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
9846 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
9847 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
9848 zero. */
9849
9850 static int
9851 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
9852 {
9853 int i = exp->nelts;
9854
9855 while (i > 0)
9856 {
9857 int oplenp, argsp;
9858
9859 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
9860 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
9861 i -= oplenp;
9862
9863 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
9864 {
9865 case BINOP_ADD:
9866 case BINOP_SUB:
9867 case BINOP_MUL:
9868 case BINOP_DIV:
9869 case BINOP_REM:
9870 case BINOP_MOD:
9871 case BINOP_LSH:
9872 case BINOP_RSH:
9873 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
9874 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
9875 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
9876 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
9877 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
9878 case BINOP_EQUAL:
9879 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
9880 case BINOP_LESS:
9881 case BINOP_GTR:
9882 case BINOP_LEQ:
9883 case BINOP_GEQ:
9884 case BINOP_REPEAT:
9885 case BINOP_COMMA:
9886 case BINOP_EXP:
9887 case BINOP_MIN:
9888 case BINOP_MAX:
9889 case BINOP_INTDIV:
9890 case BINOP_CONCAT:
9891 case TERNOP_COND:
9892 case TERNOP_SLICE:
9893
9894 case OP_LONG:
9895 case OP_FLOAT:
9896 case OP_LAST:
9897 case OP_COMPLEX:
9898 case OP_STRING:
9899 case OP_ARRAY:
9900 case OP_TYPE:
9901 case OP_TYPEOF:
9902 case OP_DECLTYPE:
9903 case OP_TYPEID:
9904 case OP_NAME:
9905 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
9906
9907 case UNOP_NEG:
9908 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
9909 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
9910 case UNOP_ADDR:
9911 case UNOP_HIGH:
9912 case UNOP_CAST:
9913
9914 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
9915 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
9916 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
9917 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
9918 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
9919 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
9920 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
9921
9922 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
9923 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
9924 ADDR is. */
9925 break;
9926
9927 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
9928 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
9929
9930 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
9931 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
9932 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
9933 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
9934
9935 We also have to check for function symbols because they
9936 are always constant. */
9937 {
9938 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
9939
9940 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
9941 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
9942 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
9943 return 0;
9944 break;
9945 }
9946
9947 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
9948 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
9949 then it is not a constant. */
9950 default:
9951 return 0;
9952 }
9953 }
9954
9955 return 1;
9956 }
9957
9958 /* Watchpoint destructor. */
9959
9960 watchpoint::~watchpoint ()
9961 {
9962 xfree (this->exp_string);
9963 xfree (this->exp_string_reparse);
9964 }
9965
9966 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
9967
9968 static void
9969 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9970 {
9971 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
9972
9973 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
9974 variables, or it can be on local variables.
9975
9976 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
9977 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
9978 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
9979 are loaded and unloaded.
9980
9981 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
9982 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
9983 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
9984 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
9985 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
9986 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
9987
9988 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
9989 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
9990 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
9991 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
9992
9993 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
9994 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
9995
9996 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
9997 reevaluated again when enabled. */
9998 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
9999 }
10000
10001 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10002
10003 static int
10004 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10005 {
10006 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10007 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10008
10009 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10010 w->cond_exp.get ());
10011 }
10012
10013 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10014
10015 static int
10016 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10017 {
10018 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10019 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10020
10021 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10022 w->cond_exp.get ());
10023 }
10024
10025 static int
10026 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10027 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10028 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10029 {
10030 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10031 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10032
10033 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10034 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10035 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10036 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10037 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10038 (did not match the data address). */
10039 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10040 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10041 return 0;
10042
10043 return 1;
10044 }
10045
10046 static void
10047 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10048 {
10049 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10050
10051 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10052 }
10053
10054 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10055 hardware watchpoints. */
10056
10057 static int
10058 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10059 {
10060 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10061 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10062
10063 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10064 }
10065
10066 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10067 hardware watchpoints. */
10068
10069 static int
10070 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10071 {
10072 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10073 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10074 }
10075
10076 static enum print_stop_action
10077 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10078 {
10079 struct breakpoint *b;
10080 enum print_stop_action result;
10081 struct watchpoint *w;
10082 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10083
10084 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10085
10086 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10087 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10088
10089 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10090 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10091
10092 string_file stb;
10093
10094 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter;
10095 switch (b->type)
10096 {
10097 case bp_watchpoint:
10098 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10099 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10100 uiout->field_string
10101 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10102 mention (b);
10103 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10104 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10105 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10106 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10107 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10108 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10109 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10110 uiout->text ("\n");
10111 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10112 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10113 break;
10114
10115 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10116 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10117 uiout->field_string
10118 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10119 mention (b);
10120 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10121 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10122 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10123 uiout->field_stream ("value", stb);
10124 uiout->text ("\n");
10125 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10126 break;
10127
10128 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10129 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10130 {
10131 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10132 uiout->field_string
10133 ("reason",
10134 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10135 mention (b);
10136 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10137 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10138 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10139 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10140 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10141 }
10142 else
10143 {
10144 mention (b);
10145 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10146 uiout->field_string
10147 ("reason",
10148 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10149 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10150 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10151 }
10152 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10153 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10154 uiout->text ("\n");
10155 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10156 break;
10157 default:
10158 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10159 }
10160
10161 return result;
10162 }
10163
10164 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10165 watchpoints. */
10166
10167 static void
10168 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10169 {
10170 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10171 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10172 const char *tuple_name;
10173
10174 switch (b->type)
10175 {
10176 case bp_watchpoint:
10177 uiout->text ("Watchpoint ");
10178 tuple_name = "wpt";
10179 break;
10180 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10181 uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint ");
10182 tuple_name = "wpt";
10183 break;
10184 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10185 uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint ");
10186 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10187 break;
10188 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10189 uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10190 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10191 break;
10192 default:
10193 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10194 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10195 }
10196
10197 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10198 uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
10199 uiout->text (": ");
10200 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10201 }
10202
10203 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10204 watchpoints. */
10205
10206 static void
10207 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10208 {
10209 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10210
10211 switch (b->type)
10212 {
10213 case bp_watchpoint:
10214 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10215 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10216 break;
10217 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10218 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10219 break;
10220 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10221 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10222 break;
10223 default:
10224 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10225 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10226 }
10227
10228 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10229 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10230 }
10231
10232 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10233 watchpoints. */
10234
10235 static int
10236 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10237 {
10238 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10239 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10240 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10241 return 0;
10242
10243 return 1;
10244 }
10245
10246 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10247
10248 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10249
10250 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10251 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10252
10253 static int
10254 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10255 {
10256 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10257
10258 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10259 bl->watchpoint_type);
10260 }
10261
10262 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10263 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10264
10265 static int
10266 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10267 {
10268 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10269
10270 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10271 bl->watchpoint_type);
10272 }
10273
10274 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10275 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10276
10277 static int
10278 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10279 {
10280 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10281
10282 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10283 }
10284
10285 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10286 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10287
10288 static int
10289 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10290 {
10291 return 0;
10292 }
10293
10294 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10295 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10296
10297 static enum print_stop_action
10298 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10299 {
10300 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10301 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10302
10303 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10304 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10305
10306 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10307 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10308
10309 switch (b->type)
10310 {
10311 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10312 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10313 uiout->field_string
10314 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10315 break;
10316
10317 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10318 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10319 uiout->field_string
10320 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10321 break;
10322
10323 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10324 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10325 uiout->field_string
10326 ("reason",
10327 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10328 break;
10329 default:
10330 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10331 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10332 }
10333
10334 mention (b);
10335 uiout->text (_("\n\
10336 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10337 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10338 uiout->text ("\n");
10339
10340 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10341 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10342 }
10343
10344 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10345 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10346
10347 static void
10348 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10349 struct ui_out *uiout)
10350 {
10351 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10352
10353 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10354 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10355
10356 uiout->text ("\tmask ");
10357 uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10358 uiout->text ("\n");
10359 }
10360
10361 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10362 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10363
10364 static void
10365 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10366 {
10367 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10368 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10369 const char *tuple_name;
10370
10371 switch (b->type)
10372 {
10373 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10374 uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10375 tuple_name = "wpt";
10376 break;
10377 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10378 uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10379 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10380 break;
10381 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10382 uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10383 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10384 break;
10385 default:
10386 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10387 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10388 }
10389
10390 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10391 uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
10392 uiout->text (": ");
10393 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10394 }
10395
10396 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10397 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10398
10399 static void
10400 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10401 {
10402 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10403
10404 switch (b->type)
10405 {
10406 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10407 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10408 break;
10409 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10410 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10411 break;
10412 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10413 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10414 break;
10415 default:
10416 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10417 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10418 }
10419
10420 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string,
10421 phex (w->hw_wp_mask, sizeof (CORE_ADDR)));
10422 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10423 }
10424
10425 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10426
10427 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10428
10429 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10430
10431 static bool
10432 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10433 {
10434 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10435 }
10436
10437 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10438 hw_read: watch read,
10439 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10440 static void
10441 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
10442 int just_location, int internal)
10443 {
10444 struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
10445 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
10446 struct value *result;
10447 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
10448 const char *exp_start = NULL;
10449 const char *exp_end = NULL;
10450 const char *tok, *end_tok;
10451 int toklen = -1;
10452 const char *cond_start = NULL;
10453 const char *cond_end = NULL;
10454 enum bptype bp_type;
10455 int thread = -1;
10456 int pc = 0;
10457 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
10458 the hardware watchpoint. */
10459 int use_mask = 0;
10460 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
10461
10462 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
10463 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
10464 {
10465 const char *value_start;
10466
10467 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
10468
10469 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
10470 of the arguments string. */
10471 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
10472 {
10473 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
10474 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10475 tok--;
10476
10477 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
10478 This is the value of the parameter. */
10479 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10480 tok--;
10481 value_start = tok + 1;
10482
10483 /* Skip whitespace. */
10484 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10485 tok--;
10486
10487 end_tok = tok;
10488
10489 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
10490 This is the parameter itself. */
10491 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10492 tok--;
10493 tok++;
10494 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
10495
10496 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
10497 {
10498 struct thread_info *thr;
10499 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
10500 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
10501 only in a specific thread. */
10502 const char *endp;
10503
10504 if (thread != -1)
10505 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
10506
10507 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
10508 thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
10509
10510 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
10511 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
10512 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
10513
10514 thread = thr->global_num;
10515 }
10516 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
10517 {
10518 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
10519 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
10520 facility. */
10521 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
10522
10523 if (use_mask)
10524 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
10525
10526 use_mask = just_location = 1;
10527
10528 mark = value_mark ();
10529 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
10530 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
10531 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10532 }
10533 else
10534 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
10535 break;
10536
10537 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
10538 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
10539 exp_end = tok;
10540 }
10541 }
10542 else
10543 exp_end = arg;
10544
10545 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
10546 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
10547 ARG. */
10548 std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg);
10549 exp_start = arg = expression.c_str ();
10550 innermost_block_tracker tracker;
10551 expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker);
10552 exp_end = arg;
10553 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
10554 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
10555 prettier. */
10556 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
10557 --exp_end;
10558
10559 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
10560 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ()))
10561 {
10562 int len;
10563
10564 len = exp_end - exp_start;
10565 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
10566 len--;
10567 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
10568 }
10569
10570 exp_valid_block = tracker.block ();
10571 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
10572 struct value *val_as_value = nullptr;
10573 fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), &pc, &val_as_value, &result, NULL,
10574 just_location);
10575
10576 if (val_as_value != NULL && just_location)
10577 {
10578 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val_as_value);
10579 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val_as_value);
10580 }
10581
10582 value_ref_ptr val;
10583 if (just_location)
10584 {
10585 int ret;
10586
10587 exp_valid_block = NULL;
10588 val = release_value (value_addr (result));
10589 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10590
10591 if (use_mask)
10592 {
10593 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val.get ()),
10594 mask);
10595 if (ret == -1)
10596 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
10597 else if (ret == -2)
10598 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
10599 }
10600 }
10601 else if (val_as_value != NULL)
10602 val = release_value (val_as_value);
10603
10604 tok = skip_spaces (arg);
10605 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
10606
10607 toklen = end_tok - tok;
10608 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
10609 {
10610 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
10611 innermost_block_tracker if_tracker;
10612 parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0, &if_tracker);
10613
10614 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
10615 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
10616 cond_exp_valid_block = if_tracker.block ();
10617
10618 cond_end = tok;
10619 }
10620 if (*tok)
10621 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
10622
10623 frame_info *wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
10624
10625 /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates
10626 'wp_frame'. */
10627 frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame);
10628
10629 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
10630 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
10631 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
10632 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
10633 if (exp_valid_block != NULL && wp_frame != NULL)
10634 {
10635 frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame);
10636
10637 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
10638 {
10639 gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame);
10640 CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame);
10641
10642 scope_breakpoint
10643 = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc,
10644 bp_watchpoint_scope,
10645 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
10646
10647 /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */
10648 wp_frame = NULL;
10649
10650 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10651
10652 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
10653 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
10654
10655 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
10656 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id;
10657
10658 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
10659 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch = caller_arch;
10660 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address = caller_pc;
10661 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
10662 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
10663 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
10664 scope_breakpoint->type);
10665 }
10666 }
10667
10668 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
10669 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
10670 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
10671 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
10672
10673 if (accessflag == hw_read)
10674 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
10675 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
10676 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
10677 else
10678 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10679
10680 std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w (new watchpoint ());
10681
10682 if (use_mask)
10683 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10684 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10685 else
10686 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10687 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10688 w->thread = thread;
10689 w->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10690 w->pspace = current_program_space;
10691 w->exp = std::move (exp);
10692 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
10693 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
10694 if (just_location)
10695 {
10696 struct type *t = value_type (val.get ());
10697 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val.get ());
10698
10699 w->exp_string_reparse
10700 = current_language->la_watch_location_expression (t, addr).release ();
10701
10702 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
10703 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
10704 }
10705 else
10706 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
10707
10708 if (use_mask)
10709 {
10710 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
10711 }
10712 else
10713 {
10714 w->val = val;
10715 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
10716 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
10717 w->val_valid = true;
10718 }
10719
10720 if (cond_start)
10721 w->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
10722 else
10723 w->cond_string = 0;
10724
10725 if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame))
10726 {
10727 w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame;
10728 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
10729 }
10730 else
10731 {
10732 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
10733 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
10734 }
10735
10736 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
10737 {
10738 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
10739 need to act on them together. */
10740 w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
10741 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get ();
10742 }
10743
10744 if (!just_location)
10745 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10746
10747 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
10748 that should be inserted. */
10749 update_watchpoint (w.get (), 1);
10750
10751 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1);
10752 }
10753
10754 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
10755 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
10756
10757 static int
10758 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals)
10759 {
10760 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
10761
10762 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
10763 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
10764 return 0;
10765
10766 gdb_assert (!vals.empty ());
10767 struct value *head = vals[0].get ();
10768
10769 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
10770 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
10771 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
10772 hardware watchpoint.
10773
10774 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
10775 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
10776 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
10777 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
10778 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
10779 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
10780 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
10781 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
10782 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
10783
10784 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
10785 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
10786 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
10787 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
10788 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : vals)
10789 {
10790 struct value *v = iter.get ();
10791
10792 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
10793 {
10794 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
10795 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
10796 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
10797 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
10798 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
10799 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
10800 ;
10801 else
10802 {
10803 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
10804 it with hardware watchpoints. */
10805 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
10806
10807 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
10808 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
10809 middle of some value chain. */
10810 if (v == head
10811 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10812 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
10813 {
10814 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
10815 int len;
10816 int num_regs;
10817
10818 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
10819 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
10820 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
10821
10822 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
10823 if (!num_regs)
10824 return 0;
10825 else
10826 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
10827 }
10828 }
10829 }
10830 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
10831 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
10832 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
10833 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
10834 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
10835 }
10836
10837 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
10838 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
10839 return found_memory_cnt;
10840 }
10841
10842 void
10843 watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10844 {
10845 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
10846 }
10847
10848 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
10849 calls watch_command_1. */
10850
10851 static void
10852 watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
10853 {
10854 int just_location = 0;
10855
10856 if (arg
10857 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
10858 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
10859 just_location = 1;
10860
10861 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
10862 }
10863
10864 static void
10865 watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10866 {
10867 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
10868 }
10869
10870 void
10871 rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10872 {
10873 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
10874 }
10875
10876 static void
10877 rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10878 {
10879 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
10880 }
10881
10882 void
10883 awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10884 {
10885 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
10886 }
10887
10888 static void
10889 awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10890 {
10891 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
10892 }
10893 \f
10894
10895 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
10896 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
10897 breakpoints. */
10898
10899 struct until_break_fsm : public thread_fsm
10900 {
10901 /* The thread that was current when the command was executed. */
10902 int thread;
10903
10904 /* The breakpoint set at the destination location. */
10905 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint;
10906
10907 /* Breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame. May be
10908 NULL. */
10909 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint;
10910
10911 until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
10912 breakpoint_up &&location_breakpoint,
10913 breakpoint_up &&caller_breakpoint)
10914 : thread_fsm (cmd_interp),
10915 thread (thread),
10916 location_breakpoint (std::move (location_breakpoint)),
10917 caller_breakpoint (std::move (caller_breakpoint))
10918 {
10919 }
10920
10921 void clean_up (struct thread_info *thread) override;
10922 bool should_stop (struct thread_info *thread) override;
10923 enum async_reply_reason do_async_reply_reason () override;
10924 };
10925
10926 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
10927 until(location)/advance commands. */
10928
10929 bool
10930 until_break_fsm::should_stop (struct thread_info *tp)
10931 {
10932 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
10933 location_breakpoint.get ()) != NULL
10934 || (caller_breakpoint != NULL
10935 && bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
10936 caller_breakpoint.get ()) != NULL))
10937 set_finished ();
10938
10939 return true;
10940 }
10941
10942 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
10943 until(location)/advance commands. */
10944
10945 void
10946 until_break_fsm::clean_up (struct thread_info *)
10947 {
10948 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
10949 location_breakpoint.reset ();
10950 caller_breakpoint.reset ();
10951 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (thread);
10952 }
10953
10954 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
10955 until(location)/advance commands. */
10956
10957 enum async_reply_reason
10958 until_break_fsm::do_async_reply_reason ()
10959 {
10960 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
10961 }
10962
10963 void
10964 until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
10965 {
10966 struct frame_info *frame;
10967 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
10968 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
10969 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
10970 int thread;
10971 struct thread_info *tp;
10972
10973 clear_proceed_status (0);
10974
10975 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
10976 this function. */
10977
10978 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10979
10980 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals
10981 = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
10982 ? decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
10983 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
10984 get_last_displayed_line ())
10985 : decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
10986 NULL, NULL, 0));
10987
10988 if (sals.size () != 1)
10989 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
10990
10991 symtab_and_line &sal = sals[0];
10992
10993 if (*arg)
10994 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
10995
10996 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
10997
10998 tp = inferior_thread ();
10999 thread = tp->global_num;
11000
11001 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11002 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11003 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11004 that. */
11005
11006 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11007 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11008 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11009 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11010
11011 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11012 one. */
11013
11014 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint;
11015
11016 gdb::optional<delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup> lj_deleter;
11017
11018 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11019 {
11020 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11021 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
11022
11023 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11024 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11025 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11026 caller_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch,
11027 sal2,
11028 caller_frame_id,
11029 bp_until);
11030
11031 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11032 lj_deleter.emplace (thread);
11033 }
11034
11035 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11036 frame = NULL;
11037
11038 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint;
11039 if (anywhere)
11040 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11041 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11042 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11043 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11044 else
11045 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11046 only at the very same frame. */
11047 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11048 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11049
11050 tp->thread_fsm = new until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
11051 std::move (location_breakpoint),
11052 std::move (caller_breakpoint));
11053
11054 if (lj_deleter)
11055 lj_deleter->release ();
11056
11057 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11058 }
11059
11060 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11061 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11062
11063 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11064 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11065 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11066 if clause in the arg string. */
11067
11068 const char *
11069 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (const char **arg)
11070 {
11071 const char *cond_string;
11072
11073 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11074 return NULL;
11075
11076 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11077 (*arg) += 2;
11078
11079 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11080 condition string. */
11081 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11082 cond_string = *arg;
11083
11084 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11085 string. */
11086 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11087
11088 return cond_string;
11089 }
11090
11091 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11092 process start/exit, etc. */
11093
11094 typedef enum
11095 {
11096 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11097 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11098 }
11099 catch_fork_kind;
11100
11101 static void
11102 catch_fork_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11103 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11104 {
11105 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11106 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11107 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11108 int tempflag;
11109
11110 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11111 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11112 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11113
11114 if (!arg)
11115 arg = "";
11116 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11117
11118 /* The allowed syntax is:
11119 catch [v]fork
11120 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11121
11122 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11123 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11124
11125 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11126 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11127
11128 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11129 and enable reporting of such events. */
11130 switch (fork_kind)
11131 {
11132 case catch_fork_temporary:
11133 case catch_fork_permanent:
11134 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11135 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11136 break;
11137 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11138 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11139 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11140 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11141 break;
11142 default:
11143 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11144 break;
11145 }
11146 }
11147
11148 static void
11149 catch_exec_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11150 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11151 {
11152 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11153 int tempflag;
11154 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11155
11156 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11157
11158 if (!arg)
11159 arg = "";
11160 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11161
11162 /* The allowed syntax is:
11163 catch exec
11164 catch exec if <cond>
11165
11166 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11167 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11168
11169 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11170 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11171
11172 std::unique_ptr<exec_catchpoint> c (new exec_catchpoint ());
11173 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11174 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11175 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11176
11177 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
11178 }
11179
11180 void
11181 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11182 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11183 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11184 const char *addr_string,
11185 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11186 int tempflag,
11187 int enabled,
11188 int from_tty)
11189 {
11190 if (from_tty)
11191 {
11192 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11193 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11194 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11195
11196 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11197 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11198 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11199 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11200 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11201 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11202 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11203 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11204 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11205 enough for now, though. */
11206 }
11207
11208 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
11209
11210 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11211 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11212 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11213 language_def (language_ada));
11214 b->language = language_ada;
11215 }
11216
11217 static void
11218 catch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11219 {
11220 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11221 }
11222 \f
11223
11224 static void
11225 tcatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11226 {
11227 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11228 }
11229
11230 /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */
11231
11232 static int
11233 compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11234 {
11235 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a;
11236 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b;
11237
11238 if (a->number < b->number)
11239 return -1;
11240 else if (a->number > b->number)
11241 return 1;
11242
11243 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11244 the number 0. */
11245 if (ua < ub)
11246 return -1;
11247 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
11248 }
11249
11250 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11251
11252 static void
11253 clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11254 {
11255 struct breakpoint *b;
11256 int default_match;
11257
11258 std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals;
11259 symtab_and_line last_sal;
11260 gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals;
11261 if (arg)
11262 {
11263 decoded_sals
11264 = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
11265 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11266 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
11267 default_match = 0;
11268 sals = decoded_sals;
11269 }
11270 else
11271 {
11272 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11273 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11274 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11275 last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
11276 if (last_sal.symtab == 0)
11277 error (_("No source file specified."));
11278
11279 default_match = 1;
11280 sals = last_sal;
11281 }
11282
11283 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11284 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11285 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11286 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11287
11288 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11289 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11290 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11291 due to optimization, all in one block.
11292
11293 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11294 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11295 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11296 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11297 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11298 to support that. */
11299
11300 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11301 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11302 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11303 breakpoint. */
11304
11305 std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found;
11306 for (const auto &sal : sals)
11307 {
11308 const char *sal_fullname;
11309
11310 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11311 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11312 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11313 or at default pc.
11314
11315 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11316
11317 0 1 pc
11318 1 1 pc _and_ line
11319 0 0 line
11320 1 0 <can't happen> */
11321
11322 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
11323 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
11324
11325 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11326 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11327 {
11328 int match = 0;
11329 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11330 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
11331 {
11332 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
11333 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
11334 {
11335 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11336 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11337 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
11338 && sal.pc
11339 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
11340 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
11341 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
11342 || loc->section == sal.section));
11343 int line_match = 0;
11344
11345 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
11346 && loc->symtab != NULL
11347 && sal_fullname != NULL
11348 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
11349 && loc->line_number == sal.line
11350 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
11351 sal_fullname) == 0)
11352 line_match = 1;
11353
11354 if (pc_match || line_match)
11355 {
11356 match = 1;
11357 break;
11358 }
11359 }
11360 }
11361
11362 if (match)
11363 found.push_back (b);
11364 }
11365 }
11366
11367 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
11368 if (found.empty ())
11369 {
11370 if (arg)
11371 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
11372 else
11373 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
11374 }
11375
11376 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
11377 std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (),
11378 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11379 {
11380 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) < 0;
11381 });
11382 found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (),
11383 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11384 {
11385 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) == 0;
11386 }),
11387 found.end ());
11388
11389 if (found.size () > 1)
11390 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
11391 if (from_tty)
11392 {
11393 if (found.size () == 1)
11394 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
11395 else
11396 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
11397 }
11398
11399 for (breakpoint *iter : found)
11400 {
11401 if (from_tty)
11402 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", iter->number);
11403 delete_breakpoint (iter);
11404 }
11405 if (from_tty)
11406 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
11407 }
11408 \f
11409 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11410 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11411 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11412
11413 void
11414 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
11415 {
11416 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
11417
11418 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
11419 if (bs->breakpoint_at
11420 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
11421 && bs->stop)
11422 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
11423
11424 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
11425 {
11426 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
11427 delete_breakpoint (b);
11428 }
11429 }
11430
11431 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
11432 std::sort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
11433 bl_address_is_meaningful says), secondarily by ordering first
11434 permanent elements and terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted
11435 stable way despite std::sort being an unstable algorithm. */
11436
11437 static int
11438 bp_location_is_less_than (const bp_location *a, const bp_location *b)
11439 {
11440 if (a->address != b->address)
11441 return a->address < b->address;
11442
11443 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
11444 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
11445 grouped. */
11446
11447 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
11448 return a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num;
11449
11450 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
11451 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
11452 return a->permanent > b->permanent;
11453
11454 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
11455 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
11456 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
11457
11458 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
11459 return a->owner->number < b->owner->number;
11460
11461 return a < b;
11462 }
11463
11464 /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and
11465 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
11466 content of the bp_locations array. */
11467
11468 static void
11469 bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void)
11470 {
11471 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
11472
11473 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
11474 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
11475
11476 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
11477 {
11478 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
11479
11480 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
11481 continue;
11482
11483 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
11484 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
11485
11486 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
11487 addr = bl->address - start;
11488 if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
11489 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
11490
11491 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
11492
11493 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
11494 addr = end - bl->address;
11495 if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max)
11496 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
11497 }
11498 }
11499
11500 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
11501
11502 static void
11503 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
11504 {
11505 struct breakpoint *b;
11506 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
11507
11508 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
11509
11510 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
11511 {
11512 struct bp_location *bl;
11513 struct tracepoint *t;
11514 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
11515
11516 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
11517 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
11518 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
11519 continue;
11520
11521 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
11522 {
11523 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
11524 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
11525 else
11526 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
11527 }
11528
11529 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
11530 break;
11531
11532 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
11533 {
11534 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
11535 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
11536 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
11537 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
11538 continue;
11539
11540 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
11541
11542 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
11543
11544 bl->inserted = 1;
11545 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
11546 }
11547 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
11548 t->number_on_target = b->number;
11549 if (bp_location_downloaded)
11550 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
11551 }
11552 }
11553
11554 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
11555
11556 static void
11557 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
11558 {
11559 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
11560 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
11561 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
11562 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
11563
11564 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
11565 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
11566 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
11567 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
11568 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
11569
11570 left->inserted = right->inserted;
11571 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
11572 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
11573 left->target_info = right->target_info;
11574 right->inserted = left_inserted;
11575 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
11576 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
11577 right->target_info = left_target_info;
11578 }
11579
11580 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
11581 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
11582 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
11583 the target. */
11584
11585 static void
11586 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
11587 {
11588 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
11589 struct bp_location *loc;
11590 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
11591 int pspace_num;
11592
11593 address = bl->address;
11594 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
11595
11596 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
11597 evaluating conditions and if the user has
11598 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
11599 side. */
11600 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
11601 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
11602 return;
11603
11604 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
11605 the same program space as the location
11606 as "its condition has changed". We need to
11607 update the conditions on the target's side. */
11608 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
11609 {
11610 loc = *loc2p;
11611
11612 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
11613 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
11614 continue;
11615
11616 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
11617 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
11618 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
11619 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
11620 that have already been marked. */
11621 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
11622
11623 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
11624 it later on. */
11625 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
11626 }
11627 }
11628 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
11629 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
11630 locations are duplicate of which.
11631
11632 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
11633 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
11634 info. */
11635
11636 static void
11637 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
11638 {
11639 struct breakpoint *b;
11640 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
11641 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
11642 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
11643 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
11644 int last_pspace_num = -1;
11645
11646 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
11647 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
11648 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
11649 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
11650 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
11651 once. */
11652 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
11653 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
11654 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
11655 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
11656
11657 /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly
11658 built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
11659 struct bp_location **old_locp;
11660 unsigned old_locations_count;
11661 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<struct bp_location *> old_locations (bp_locations);
11662
11663 old_locations_count = bp_locations_count;
11664 bp_locations = NULL;
11665 bp_locations_count = 0;
11666
11667 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11668 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11669 bp_locations_count++;
11670
11671 bp_locations = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_locations_count);
11672 locp = bp_locations;
11673 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11674 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11675 *locp++ = loc;
11676 std::sort (bp_locations, bp_locations + bp_locations_count,
11677 bp_location_is_less_than);
11678
11679 bp_locations_target_extensions_update ();
11680
11681 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
11682 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
11683 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
11684 if there's another location at the same address (previously
11685 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
11686 location.
11687
11688 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
11689 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
11690
11691 locp = bp_locations;
11692 for (old_locp = old_locations.get ();
11693 old_locp < old_locations.get () + old_locations_count;
11694 old_locp++)
11695 {
11696 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
11697 struct bp_location **loc2p;
11698
11699 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
11700 not, we have to free it. */
11701 int found_object = 0;
11702 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
11703 int keep_in_target = 0;
11704 int removed = 0;
11705
11706 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
11707 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
11708 while (locp < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11709 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
11710 locp++;
11711
11712 for (loc2p = locp;
11713 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11714 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11715 loc2p++)
11716 {
11717 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
11718 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
11719 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
11720 place there. */
11721 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
11722 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
11723 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
11724 {
11725 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
11726 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
11727 }
11728
11729 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
11730 found_object = 1;
11731 }
11732
11733 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
11734 have to go through updates again. */
11735 last_addr = old_loc->address;
11736
11737 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
11738 if (!found_object)
11739 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
11740
11741 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
11742 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
11743 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
11744 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
11745 at certain location is not inserted. */
11746
11747 if (old_loc->inserted)
11748 {
11749 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
11750 it. */
11751
11752 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
11753 {
11754 /* The location is still present in the location list,
11755 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
11756 keep_in_target = 1;
11757 }
11758 else
11759 {
11760 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
11761 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
11762 remove its target-side condition. */
11763
11764 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
11765 disabled. See if there's another location at the
11766 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
11767 this one from the target. */
11768
11769 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
11770 if (bl_address_is_meaningful (old_loc))
11771 {
11772 for (loc2p = locp;
11773 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11774 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11775 loc2p++)
11776 {
11777 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
11778
11779 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
11780 {
11781 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
11782 access watchpoints, if the former are not
11783 supported, but the latter are. */
11784 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
11785 {
11786 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
11787 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
11788 }
11789
11790 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
11791 if it should be inserted in case it will be
11792 unduplicated. */
11793 if (loc2 != old_loc
11794 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
11795 {
11796 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
11797 keep_in_target = 1;
11798 break;
11799 }
11800 }
11801 }
11802 }
11803 }
11804
11805 if (!keep_in_target)
11806 {
11807 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
11808 {
11809 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
11810 this location on the global list, and try to
11811 remove it next time, but there's no particular
11812 reason why we will succeed next time.
11813
11814 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
11815 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
11816 only after calling us. */
11817 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
11818 "breakpoint %d\n"),
11819 old_loc->owner->number);
11820 }
11821 removed = 1;
11822 }
11823 }
11824
11825 if (!found_object)
11826 {
11827 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
11828 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
11829 {
11830 /* This location was removed from the target. In
11831 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
11832 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
11833 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
11834 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
11835 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
11836 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
11837 after we see some number of events. The theory here
11838 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
11839 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
11840 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
11841 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
11842 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
11843 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
11844 SIGTRAP.
11845
11846 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
11847 decr_pc_after_break targets.
11848
11849 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
11850 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
11851 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
11852 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
11853 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
11854 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
11855 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
11856 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
11857 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
11858 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
11859 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
11860 targets that do not support new thread events, like
11861 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
11862 thread_count.
11863
11864 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
11865 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
11866 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
11867 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
11868
11869 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
11870 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
11871 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
11872 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
11873 traps we can no longer explain. */
11874
11875 process_stratum_target *proc_target = nullptr;
11876 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
11877 if (inf->pspace == old_loc->pspace)
11878 {
11879 proc_target = inf->process_target ();
11880 break;
11881 }
11882 if (proc_target != nullptr)
11883 old_loc->events_till_retirement
11884 = 3 * (thread_count (proc_target) + 1);
11885 else
11886 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 1;
11887 old_loc->owner = NULL;
11888
11889 moribund_locations.push_back (old_loc);
11890 }
11891 else
11892 {
11893 old_loc->owner = NULL;
11894 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
11895 }
11896 }
11897 }
11898
11899 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
11900 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
11901 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
11902 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
11903 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
11904 are sorted first for the same address.
11905
11906 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
11907 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
11908
11909 bp_loc_first = NULL;
11910 wp_loc_first = NULL;
11911 awp_loc_first = NULL;
11912 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
11913 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
11914 {
11915 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
11916 non-NULL. */
11917 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
11918 b = loc->owner;
11919
11920 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
11921 || !bl_address_is_meaningful (loc)
11922 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
11923 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
11924 `struct bp_location'. */
11925 || is_tracepoint (b))
11926 {
11927 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
11928 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
11929 continue;
11930 }
11931
11932 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
11933 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
11934 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
11935 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
11936 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
11937 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
11938 else
11939 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
11940
11941 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
11942 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
11943 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
11944 {
11945 *loc_first_p = loc;
11946 loc->duplicate = 0;
11947
11948 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
11949 {
11950 loc->needs_update = 1;
11951 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
11952 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
11953 }
11954 continue;
11955 }
11956
11957
11958 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
11959 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
11960 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
11961 if (loc->inserted)
11962 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
11963 loc->duplicate = 1;
11964
11965 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
11966 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
11967 }
11968
11969 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
11970 {
11971 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
11972 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
11973 else
11974 {
11975 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
11976 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
11977 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
11978 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
11979 only update conditions for locations that are marked
11980 "needs_update". */
11981 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
11982 }
11983 }
11984
11985 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
11986 download_tracepoint_locations ();
11987 }
11988
11989 void
11990 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
11991 {
11992 for (int ix = 0; ix < moribund_locations.size (); ++ix)
11993 {
11994 struct bp_location *loc = moribund_locations[ix];
11995 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
11996 {
11997 decref_bp_location (&loc);
11998 unordered_remove (moribund_locations, ix);
11999 --ix;
12000 }
12001 }
12002 }
12003
12004 static void
12005 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12006 {
12007
12008 try
12009 {
12010 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12011 }
12012 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
12013 {
12014 }
12015 }
12016
12017 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12018
12019 static void
12020 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12021 {
12022 bpstat bs;
12023
12024 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12025 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12026 {
12027 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12028 bs->old_val = NULL;
12029 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12030 }
12031 }
12032
12033 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12034 static int
12035 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12036 {
12037 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
12038
12039 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12040 return 0;
12041 }
12042
12043 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12044 callbacks. */
12045
12046 static void
12047 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12048 {
12049 struct value_print_options opts;
12050
12051 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12052
12053 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12054 single string. */
12055 if (b->loc == NULL)
12056 {
12057 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12058 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12059 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12060 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12061 {
12062 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12063 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12064 }
12065 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12066 {
12067 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12068 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12069 b->extra_string);
12070 }
12071 else
12072 {
12073 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12074 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12075 b->extra_string);
12076 }
12077 }
12078 else
12079 {
12080 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12081 printf_filtered (" at %ps",
12082 styled_string (address_style.style (),
12083 paddress (b->loc->gdbarch,
12084 b->loc->address)));
12085 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12086 {
12087 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12088 more nicely. */
12089 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12090 {
12091 const char *filename
12092 = symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab);
12093 printf_filtered (": file %ps, line %d.",
12094 styled_string (file_name_style.style (),
12095 filename),
12096 b->loc->line_number);
12097 }
12098 else
12099 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12100 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12101 real situation somewhat. */
12102 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12103 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12104 }
12105
12106 if (b->loc->next)
12107 {
12108 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12109 int n = 0;
12110 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12111 ++n;
12112 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12113 }
12114 }
12115 }
12116
12117 bp_location::~bp_location ()
12118 {
12119 xfree (function_name);
12120 }
12121
12122 /* Destructor for the breakpoint base class. */
12123
12124 breakpoint::~breakpoint ()
12125 {
12126 xfree (this->cond_string);
12127 xfree (this->extra_string);
12128 }
12129
12130 static struct bp_location *
12131 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12132 {
12133 return new bp_location (self);
12134 }
12135
12136 static void
12137 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12138 {
12139 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12140 }
12141
12142 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12143 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12144
12145 static int
12146 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12147 {
12148 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12149 }
12150
12151 static int
12152 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12153 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12154 {
12155 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12156 }
12157
12158 static int
12159 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12160 const address_space *aspace,
12161 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12162 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12163 {
12164 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12165 }
12166
12167 static void
12168 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12169 {
12170 /* Always stop. */
12171 }
12172
12173 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12174 errors. */
12175
12176 static int
12177 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12178 {
12179 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12180 }
12181
12182 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12183 errors. */
12184
12185 static int
12186 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12187 {
12188 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12189 }
12190
12191 static enum print_stop_action
12192 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12193 {
12194 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12195 }
12196
12197 static void
12198 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12199 struct ui_out *uiout)
12200 {
12201 /* nothing */
12202 }
12203
12204 static void
12205 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12206 {
12207 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12208 }
12209
12210 static void
12211 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12212 {
12213 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12214 }
12215
12216 static void
12217 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
12218 (const struct event_location *location,
12219 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12220 enum bptype type_wanted)
12221 {
12222 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12223 }
12224
12225 static void
12226 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12227 struct linespec_result *c,
12228 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12229 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12230 enum bptype type_wanted,
12231 enum bpdisp disposition,
12232 int thread,
12233 int task, int ignore_count,
12234 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
12235 int from_tty, int enabled,
12236 int internal, unsigned flags)
12237 {
12238 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12239 }
12240
12241 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12242 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12243 const struct event_location *location,
12244 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12245 {
12246 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12247 }
12248
12249 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
12250
12251 static int
12252 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
12253 {
12254 return 1;
12255 }
12256
12257 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
12258
12259 static void
12260 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12261 {
12262 /* Nothing to do. */
12263 }
12264
12265 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
12266 {
12267 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
12268 base_breakpoint_re_set,
12269 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
12270 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
12271 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
12272 base_breakpoint_check_status,
12273 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
12274 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
12275 base_breakpoint_print_it,
12276 NULL,
12277 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
12278 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
12279 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
12280 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
12281 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
12282 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
12283 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
12284 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
12285 };
12286
12287 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12288
12289 static void
12290 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12291 {
12292 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12293 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
12294 {
12295 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
12296 delete_breakpoint (b);
12297 return;
12298 }
12299
12300 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12301 }
12302
12303 static int
12304 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12305 {
12306 CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address;
12307
12308 bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
12309 bl->target_info.placed_address = addr;
12310
12311 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12312 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12313 else
12314 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12315 }
12316
12317 static int
12318 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12319 {
12320 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12321 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12322 else
12323 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
12324 }
12325
12326 static int
12327 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12328 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12329 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12330 {
12331 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12332 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
12333 return 0;
12334
12335 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
12336 aspace, bp_addr))
12337 return 0;
12338
12339 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
12340 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
12341 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
12342 return 0;
12343
12344 return 1;
12345 }
12346
12347 static int
12348 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12349 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12350 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12351 {
12352 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
12353 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
12354 {
12355 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
12356 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
12357 be set at the same address. */
12358 return 0;
12359 }
12360
12361 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
12362 }
12363
12364 static int
12365 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12366 {
12367 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
12368
12369 return 1;
12370 }
12371
12372 static enum print_stop_action
12373 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12374 {
12375 struct breakpoint *b;
12376 const struct bp_location *bl;
12377 int bp_temp;
12378 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12379
12380 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
12381
12382 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
12383 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12384
12385 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
12386 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
12387 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
12388 bl->address,
12389 b->number, 1);
12390 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
12391 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
12392
12393 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12394 {
12395 uiout->field_string ("reason",
12396 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12397 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12398 }
12399 if (bp_temp)
12400 uiout->message ("Temporary breakpoint %pF, ",
12401 signed_field ("bkptno", b->number));
12402 else
12403 uiout->message ("Breakpoint %pF, ",
12404 signed_field ("bkptno", b->number));
12405
12406 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12407 }
12408
12409 static void
12410 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12411 {
12412 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12413 return;
12414
12415 switch (b->type)
12416 {
12417 case bp_breakpoint:
12418 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
12419 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
12420 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12421 else
12422 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
12423 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12424 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
12425 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
12426 break;
12427 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
12428 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
12429 break;
12430 case bp_dprintf:
12431 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
12432 break;
12433 }
12434
12435 say_where (b);
12436 }
12437
12438 static void
12439 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12440 {
12441 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12442 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
12443 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
12444 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
12445 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
12446 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12447 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
12448 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
12449 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
12450 else
12451 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12452 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
12453
12454 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12455 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()));
12456
12457 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
12458 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
12459 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
12460 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
12461
12462 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12463 }
12464
12465 static void
12466 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12467 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12468 enum bptype type_wanted)
12469 {
12470 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12471 }
12472
12473 static void
12474 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12475 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12476 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12477 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12478 enum bptype type_wanted,
12479 enum bpdisp disposition,
12480 int thread,
12481 int task, int ignore_count,
12482 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12483 int from_tty, int enabled,
12484 int internal, unsigned flags)
12485 {
12486 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12487 std::move (cond_string),
12488 std::move (extra_string),
12489 type_wanted,
12490 disposition, thread, task,
12491 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12492 enabled, internal, flags);
12493 }
12494
12495 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12496 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12497 const struct event_location *location,
12498 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12499 {
12500 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12501 }
12502
12503 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
12504
12505 static void
12506 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12507 {
12508 switch (b->type)
12509 {
12510 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
12511 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
12512 case bp_overlay_event:
12513 case bp_longjmp_master:
12514 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12515 case bp_exception_master:
12516 delete_breakpoint (b);
12517 break;
12518
12519 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
12520 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
12521 case bp_shlib_event:
12522
12523 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
12524 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
12525 case bp_thread_event:
12526 break;
12527 }
12528 }
12529
12530 static void
12531 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12532 {
12533 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
12534 {
12535 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
12536 events. This allows the user to get control and place
12537 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
12538 objects (among other things). */
12539 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
12540 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
12541 }
12542 else
12543 bs->stop = 0;
12544 }
12545
12546 static enum print_stop_action
12547 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12548 {
12549 struct breakpoint *b;
12550
12551 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12552
12553 switch (b->type)
12554 {
12555 case bp_shlib_event:
12556 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
12557 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
12558 to shlib event" message.) */
12559 print_solib_event (0);
12560 break;
12561
12562 case bp_thread_event:
12563 /* Not sure how we will get here.
12564 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
12565 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12566 break;
12567
12568 case bp_overlay_event:
12569 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
12570 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12571 break;
12572
12573 case bp_longjmp_master:
12574 /* These should never be enabled. */
12575 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12576 break;
12577
12578 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12579 /* These should never be enabled. */
12580 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
12581 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12582 break;
12583
12584 case bp_exception_master:
12585 /* These should never be enabled. */
12586 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
12587 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12588 break;
12589 }
12590
12591 return PRINT_NOTHING;
12592 }
12593
12594 static void
12595 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12596 {
12597 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12598 }
12599
12600 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
12601
12602 static void
12603 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12604 {
12605 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
12606 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
12607 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
12608 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
12609 }
12610
12611 static void
12612 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12613 {
12614 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
12615 }
12616
12617 static enum print_stop_action
12618 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12619 {
12620 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
12621 }
12622
12623 static void
12624 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12625 {
12626 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12627 }
12628
12629 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
12630
12631 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
12632 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
12633
12634 longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint ()
12635 {
12636 thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread);
12637
12638 if (tp != NULL)
12639 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
12640 }
12641
12642 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
12643
12644 static int
12645 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12646 {
12647 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
12648
12649 if (v == 0)
12650 {
12651 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
12652 if needed. */
12653 bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12654 }
12655
12656 return v;
12657 }
12658
12659 static int
12660 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12661 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12662 {
12663 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
12664 bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12665
12666 return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
12667 }
12668
12669 static void
12670 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12671 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12672 enum bptype type_wanted)
12673 {
12674 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12675
12676 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
12677 lsal.canonical
12678 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12679 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12680 }
12681
12682 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12683 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12684 const struct event_location *location,
12685 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12686 {
12687 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
12688 if (sals.empty ())
12689 error (_("probe not found"));
12690 return sals;
12691 }
12692
12693 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
12694
12695 static void
12696 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12697 {
12698 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12699 }
12700
12701 static int
12702 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12703 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12704 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12705 {
12706 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
12707 tracepoints. */
12708 return 0;
12709 }
12710
12711 static void
12712 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12713 struct ui_out *uiout)
12714 {
12715 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12716 if (!tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
12717 {
12718 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
12719
12720 uiout->message ("\tmarker id is %pF\n",
12721 string_field ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
12722 tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()));
12723 }
12724 }
12725
12726 static void
12727 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12728 {
12729 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12730 return;
12731
12732 switch (b->type)
12733 {
12734 case bp_tracepoint:
12735 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
12736 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12737 break;
12738 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
12739 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
12740 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12741 break;
12742 case bp_static_tracepoint:
12743 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
12744 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12745 break;
12746 default:
12747 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12748 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
12749 }
12750
12751 say_where (b);
12752 }
12753
12754 static void
12755 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
12756 {
12757 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12758
12759 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
12760 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
12761 else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
12762 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
12763 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
12764 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
12765 else
12766 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12767 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
12768
12769 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12770 event_location_to_string (self->location.get ()));
12771 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
12772
12773 if (tp->pass_count)
12774 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
12775 }
12776
12777 static void
12778 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12779 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12780 enum bptype type_wanted)
12781 {
12782 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12783 }
12784
12785 static void
12786 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12787 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12788 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12789 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12790 enum bptype type_wanted,
12791 enum bpdisp disposition,
12792 int thread,
12793 int task, int ignore_count,
12794 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12795 int from_tty, int enabled,
12796 int internal, unsigned flags)
12797 {
12798 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12799 std::move (cond_string),
12800 std::move (extra_string),
12801 type_wanted,
12802 disposition, thread, task,
12803 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12804 enabled, internal, flags);
12805 }
12806
12807 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12808 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12809 const struct event_location *location,
12810 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12811 {
12812 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12813 }
12814
12815 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
12816
12817 /* Virtual table for tracepoints on static probes. */
12818
12819 static void
12820 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
12821 (const struct event_location *location,
12822 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12823 enum bptype type_wanted)
12824 {
12825 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12826 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12827 }
12828
12829 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12830 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12831 const struct event_location *location,
12832 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12833 {
12834 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12835 return bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
12836 }
12837
12838 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
12839
12840 static void
12841 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12842 {
12843 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12844
12845 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
12846 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
12847
12848 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
12849 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
12850 3 - disconnect from target 1
12851 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
12852
12853 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
12854 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
12855 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
12856 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
12857 it all the time. */
12858 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
12859 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
12860 }
12861
12862 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
12863
12864 static void
12865 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12866 {
12867 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
12868 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()),
12869 tp->extra_string);
12870 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12871 }
12872
12873 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
12874 dprintf.
12875
12876 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
12877 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
12878 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
12879 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
12880 address are all handled. */
12881
12882 static void
12883 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12884 {
12885 struct bpstats tmp_bs;
12886 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
12887
12888 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
12889 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
12890 condition not be evaluated. */
12891 bs->stop = 0;
12892
12893 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
12894 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
12895 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
12896 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
12897 commands here throws. */
12898 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
12899 bs->commands = NULL;
12900
12901 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
12902
12903 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
12904 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
12905 list. */
12906 }
12907
12908 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
12909 markers (`-m'). */
12910
12911 static void
12912 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12913 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12914 enum bptype type_wanted)
12915 {
12916 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12917 const char *arg_start, *arg;
12918
12919 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
12920 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
12921
12922 std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
12923 const char *ptr = str.c_str ();
12924 canonical->location
12925 = new_linespec_location (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
12926
12927 lsal.canonical
12928 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12929 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12930 }
12931
12932 static void
12933 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12934 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12935 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12936 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12937 enum bptype type_wanted,
12938 enum bpdisp disposition,
12939 int thread,
12940 int task, int ignore_count,
12941 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12942 int from_tty, int enabled,
12943 int internal, unsigned flags)
12944 {
12945 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0];
12946
12947 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
12948 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
12949 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
12950 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
12951 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
12952 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
12953
12954 for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++)
12955 {
12956 event_location_up location
12957 = copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ());
12958
12959 std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp (new tracepoint ());
12960 init_breakpoint_sal (tp.get (), gdbarch, lsal.sals[i],
12961 std::move (location), NULL,
12962 std::move (cond_string),
12963 std::move (extra_string),
12964 type_wanted, disposition,
12965 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
12966 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
12967 canonical->special_display);
12968 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
12969 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
12970 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
12971 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
12972 try to match up which of the newly found markers
12973 corresponds to this one */
12974 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
12975
12976 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0);
12977 }
12978 }
12979
12980 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12981 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12982 const struct event_location *location,
12983 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12984 {
12985 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
12986 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
12987
12988 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
12989 if (sals.size () > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
12990 {
12991 sals[0] = sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
12992 sals.resize (1);
12993 return sals;
12994 }
12995 else
12996 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
12997 }
12998
12999 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13000
13001 static int
13002 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13003 {
13004 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13005 }
13006
13007 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13008 structures. */
13009
13010 void
13011 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13012 {
13013 struct breakpoint *b;
13014
13015 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13016
13017 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13018 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13019 especial culprits.
13020
13021 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13022 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13023 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13024 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13025 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13026 deleted.
13027
13028 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13029 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13030 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13031 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13032 was chosen. */
13033 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13034 return;
13035
13036 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13037 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13038 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13039 {
13040 struct breakpoint *related;
13041 struct watchpoint *w;
13042
13043 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13044 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13045 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13046 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13047 else
13048 w = NULL;
13049 if (w != NULL)
13050 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13051
13052 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13053 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13054 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13055 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13056 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13057 }
13058
13059 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13060 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13061 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13062 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13063 if (bpt->number)
13064 gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted.notify (bpt);
13065
13066 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13067 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13068
13069 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13070 if (b->next == bpt)
13071 {
13072 b->next = bpt->next;
13073 break;
13074 }
13075
13076 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13077 been freed. */
13078 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13079 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13080 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13081 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13082 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13083 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13084 commands won't work. */
13085
13086 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13087
13088 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13089 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13090 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13091 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13092 might be better design to have location completely
13093 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13094 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13095
13096 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13097 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13098 bpt->type = bp_none;
13099 delete bpt;
13100 }
13101
13102 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13103 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13104
13105 static void
13106 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13107 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13108 {
13109 struct breakpoint *related;
13110
13111 related = b;
13112 do
13113 {
13114 struct breakpoint *next;
13115
13116 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13117 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13118
13119 if (next == related)
13120 {
13121 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13122 function (related);
13123
13124 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13125 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13126 out. */
13127 break;
13128 }
13129 else
13130 function (related);
13131
13132 related = next;
13133 }
13134 while (related != b);
13135 }
13136
13137 static void
13138 delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
13139 {
13140 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13141
13142 dont_repeat ();
13143
13144 if (arg == 0)
13145 {
13146 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13147
13148 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13149 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13150 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13151 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13152 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13153 {
13154 breaks_to_delete = 1;
13155 break;
13156 }
13157
13158 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13159 if (!from_tty
13160 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13161 {
13162 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13163 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13164 delete_breakpoint (b);
13165 }
13166 }
13167 else
13168 map_breakpoint_numbers
13169 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
13170 {
13171 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
13172 });
13173 }
13174
13175 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
13176 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
13177 considered. */
13178
13179 static int
13180 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13181 {
13182 struct bp_location *loc;
13183
13184 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
13185 if ((pspace == NULL
13186 || loc->pspace == pspace)
13187 && !loc->shlib_disabled
13188 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13189 return 0;
13190 return 1;
13191 }
13192
13193 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13194 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13195 Null names are ignored. */
13196
13197 static int
13198 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
13199 {
13200 struct bp_location *l;
13201 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string, streq_hash, NULL,
13202 xcalloc, xfree);
13203
13204 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
13205 {
13206 const char **slot;
13207 const char *name = l->function_name;
13208
13209 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13210 if (name == NULL)
13211 continue;
13212
13213 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
13214 INSERT);
13215 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13216 returns NULL. */
13217 if (*slot != NULL)
13218 {
13219 htab_delete (htab);
13220 return 1;
13221 }
13222 *slot = name;
13223 }
13224
13225 htab_delete (htab);
13226 return 0;
13227 }
13228
13229 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13230 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13231 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13232 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13233 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13234 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13235 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13236 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13237 The heuristic is:
13238
13239 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13240 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13241 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13242 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13243 in the sources, and output a warning.
13244
13245 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13246 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13247 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13248 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13249 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13250 warning.
13251
13252 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13253 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13254 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13255 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13256 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13257 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13258 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13259 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13260 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13261
13262 static struct symtab_and_line
13263 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
13264 {
13265 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13266 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
13267 CORE_ADDR pc;
13268
13269 pc = sal.pc;
13270 if (sal.line)
13271 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
13272
13273 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
13274 {
13275 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id != marker.str_id)
13276 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13277 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str (),
13278 marker.str_id.c_str ());
13279
13280 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
13281
13282 return sal;
13283 }
13284
13285 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13286 by string ID. */
13287 if (!sal.explicit_pc
13288 && sal.line != 0
13289 && sal.symtab != NULL
13290 && !tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
13291 {
13292 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
13293 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid
13294 (tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13295
13296 if (!markers.empty ())
13297 {
13298 struct symbol *sym;
13299 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
13300 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13301 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
13302
13303 tpmarker = &markers[0];
13304
13305 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (tpmarker->str_id);
13306
13307 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
13308 "found at previous line number"),
13309 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13310
13311 symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
13312 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
13313 uiout->text ("Now in ");
13314 if (sym)
13315 {
13316 uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (),
13317 function_name_style.style ());
13318 uiout->text (" at ");
13319 }
13320 uiout->field_string ("file",
13321 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab),
13322 file_name_style.style ());
13323 uiout->text (":");
13324
13325 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
13326 {
13327 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
13328
13329 uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname);
13330 }
13331
13332 uiout->field_signed ("line", sal2.line);
13333 uiout->text ("\n");
13334
13335 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
13336 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
13337
13338 b->location.reset (NULL);
13339 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13340 explicit_loc.source_filename
13341 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13342 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
13343 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
13344 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13345
13346 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
13347 so. */
13348 }
13349 }
13350 return sal;
13351 }
13352
13353 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
13354 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
13355
13356 static int
13357 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
13358 {
13359 while (a && b)
13360 {
13361 if (a->address != b->address)
13362 return 0;
13363
13364 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
13365 return 0;
13366
13367 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
13368 return 0;
13369
13370 a = a->next;
13371 b = b->next;
13372 }
13373
13374 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
13375 return 0;
13376
13377 return 1;
13378 }
13379
13380 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
13381 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
13382 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
13383
13384 static struct bp_location *
13385 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13386 {
13387 struct bp_location head;
13388 struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
13389 struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
13390 struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
13391
13392 if (pspace == NULL)
13393 {
13394 i = b->loc;
13395 b->loc = NULL;
13396 return i;
13397 }
13398
13399 head.next = NULL;
13400
13401 while (i != NULL)
13402 {
13403 if (i->pspace == pspace)
13404 {
13405 *i_link = i->next;
13406 i->next = NULL;
13407 hoisted->next = i;
13408 hoisted = i;
13409 }
13410 else
13411 i_link = &i->next;
13412 i = *i_link;
13413 }
13414
13415 return head.next;
13416 }
13417
13418 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
13419 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
13420 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
13421 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
13422 untouched. */
13423
13424 void
13425 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
13426 struct program_space *filter_pspace,
13427 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
13428 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end)
13429 {
13430 struct bp_location *existing_locations;
13431
13432 if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1))
13433 {
13434 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
13435 location. */
13436 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13437 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
13438 "multiple locations found\n"),
13439 b->number);
13440 return;
13441 }
13442
13443 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
13444 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
13445 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
13446 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
13447 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
13448 individual locations. */
13449 if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ())
13450 return;
13451
13452 existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
13453
13454 for (const auto &sal : sals)
13455 {
13456 struct bp_location *new_loc;
13457
13458 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
13459
13460 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
13461
13462 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
13463 old symtab. */
13464 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
13465 {
13466 const char *s;
13467
13468 s = b->cond_string;
13469 try
13470 {
13471 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc,
13472 block_for_pc (sal.pc),
13473 0);
13474 }
13475 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
13476 {
13477 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
13478 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
13479 b->number, e.what ());
13480 new_loc->enabled = 0;
13481 }
13482 }
13483
13484 if (!sals_end.empty ())
13485 {
13486 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]);
13487
13488 new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1;
13489 }
13490 }
13491
13492 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
13493 breakpoints. */
13494 {
13495 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
13496 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
13497 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
13498 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
13499 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
13500 often enough until a better solution is found. */
13501 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
13502
13503 for (; e; e = e->next)
13504 {
13505 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
13506 {
13507 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
13508 if (have_ambiguous_names)
13509 {
13510 for (; l; l = l->next)
13511 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
13512 {
13513 l->enabled = 0;
13514 break;
13515 }
13516 }
13517 else
13518 {
13519 for (; l; l = l->next)
13520 if (l->function_name
13521 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
13522 {
13523 l->enabled = 0;
13524 break;
13525 }
13526 }
13527 }
13528 }
13529 }
13530
13531 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
13532 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13533 }
13534
13535 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
13536 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
13537
13538 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13539 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
13540 struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
13541 {
13542 struct gdb_exception exception;
13543
13544 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
13545
13546 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
13547
13548 try
13549 {
13550 sals = b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
13551 }
13552 catch (gdb_exception_error &e)
13553 {
13554 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
13555
13556 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
13557 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
13558 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
13559 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
13560 state, then user already saw the message about that
13561 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
13562 errors. */
13563 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
13564 && (b->condition_not_parsed
13565 || (b->loc != NULL
13566 && search_pspace != NULL
13567 && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
13568 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
13569 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13570 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
13571 not_found_and_ok = 1;
13572
13573 if (!not_found_and_ok)
13574 {
13575 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
13576 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
13577 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
13578 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
13579 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
13580 which approach is better. */
13581 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13582 throw;
13583 }
13584
13585 exception = std::move (e);
13586 }
13587
13588 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
13589 {
13590 for (auto &sal : sals)
13591 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
13592 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
13593 {
13594 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
13595 int thread, task;
13596
13597 find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals[0].pc,
13598 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
13599 &extra_string);
13600 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
13601 if (cond_string)
13602 b->cond_string = cond_string;
13603 b->thread = thread;
13604 b->task = task;
13605 if (extra_string)
13606 {
13607 xfree (b->extra_string);
13608 b->extra_string = extra_string;
13609 }
13610 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
13611 }
13612
13613 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
13614 sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals[0]);
13615
13616 *found = 1;
13617 }
13618 else
13619 *found = 0;
13620
13621 return sals;
13622 }
13623
13624 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
13625 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
13626 locations. */
13627
13628 static void
13629 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
13630 {
13631 struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
13632 std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end;
13633
13634 int found;
13635 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location.get (),
13636 filter_pspace, &found);
13637 if (found)
13638 expanded = std::move (sals);
13639
13640 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
13641 {
13642 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end
13643 = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end.get (),
13644 filter_pspace, &found);
13645 if (found)
13646 expanded_end = std::move (sals_end);
13647 }
13648
13649 update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
13650 }
13651
13652 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
13653 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
13654
13655 static void
13656 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
13657 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13658 enum bptype type_wanted)
13659 {
13660 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
13661 }
13662
13663 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
13664 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
13665 breakpoint_ops. */
13666
13667 static void
13668 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13669 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13670 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13671 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13672 enum bptype type_wanted,
13673 enum bpdisp disposition,
13674 int thread,
13675 int task, int ignore_count,
13676 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13677 int from_tty, int enabled,
13678 int internal, unsigned flags)
13679 {
13680 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical,
13681 std::move (cond_string),
13682 std::move (extra_string),
13683 type_wanted, disposition,
13684 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13685 enabled, internal, flags);
13686 }
13687
13688 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
13689 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
13690
13691 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13692 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
13693 const struct event_location *location,
13694 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13695 {
13696 struct linespec_result canonical;
13697
13698 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
13699 NULL, 0, &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
13700 b->filter.get ());
13701
13702 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
13703 gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2);
13704
13705 if (!canonical.lsals.empty ())
13706 {
13707 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
13708 return std::move (lsal.sals);
13709 }
13710 return {};
13711 }
13712
13713 /* Reset a breakpoint. */
13714
13715 static void
13716 breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b)
13717 {
13718 input_radix = b->input_radix;
13719 set_language (b->language);
13720
13721 b->ops->re_set (b);
13722 }
13723
13724 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
13725 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
13726
13727 void
13728 breakpoint_re_set (void)
13729 {
13730 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13731
13732 {
13733 scoped_restore_current_language save_language;
13734 scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix);
13735 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
13736
13737 /* breakpoint_re_set_one sets the current_language to the language
13738 of the breakpoint it is resetting (see prepare_re_set_context)
13739 before re-evaluating the breakpoint's location. This change can
13740 unfortunately get undone by accident if the language_mode is set
13741 to auto, and we either switch frames, or more likely in this context,
13742 we select the current frame.
13743
13744 We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to
13745 language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints
13746 have been reset. */
13747 scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode);
13748 language_mode = language_mode_manual;
13749
13750 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
13751 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
13752 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
13753 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
13754
13755 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13756 {
13757 try
13758 {
13759 breakpoint_re_set_one (b);
13760 }
13761 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
13762 {
13763 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
13764 "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
13765 b->number);
13766 }
13767 }
13768
13769 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
13770 }
13771
13772 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
13773 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
13774 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
13775 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
13776
13777 /* Now we can insert. */
13778 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
13779 }
13780 \f
13781 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
13782
13783 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
13784 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
13785 void
13786 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
13787 {
13788 if (b->thread != -1)
13789 {
13790 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
13791
13792 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
13793 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
13794 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
13795 as well. */
13796 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
13797 }
13798 }
13799
13800 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
13801 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
13802 which ends with a period (no newline). */
13803
13804 void
13805 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
13806 {
13807 struct breakpoint *b;
13808
13809 if (count < 0)
13810 count = 0;
13811
13812 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13813 if (b->number == bptnum)
13814 {
13815 if (is_tracepoint (b))
13816 {
13817 if (from_tty && count != 0)
13818 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
13819 bptnum);
13820 return;
13821 }
13822
13823 b->ignore_count = count;
13824 if (from_tty)
13825 {
13826 if (count == 0)
13827 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
13828 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
13829 bptnum);
13830 else if (count == 1)
13831 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
13832 bptnum);
13833 else
13834 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
13835 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
13836 count, bptnum);
13837 }
13838 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13839 return;
13840 }
13841
13842 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
13843 }
13844
13845 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
13846
13847 static void
13848 ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
13849 {
13850 const char *p = args;
13851 int num;
13852
13853 if (p == 0)
13854 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
13855
13856 num = get_number (&p);
13857 if (num == 0)
13858 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
13859 if (*p == 0)
13860 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
13861
13862 set_ignore_count (num,
13863 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
13864 from_tty);
13865 if (from_tty)
13866 printf_filtered ("\n");
13867 }
13868 \f
13869
13870 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range
13871 defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */
13872
13873 static void
13874 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range,
13875 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13876 {
13877 if (bp_num_range.first == 0)
13878 {
13879 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"),
13880 bp_num_range.first);
13881 }
13882 else
13883 {
13884 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
13885
13886 for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++)
13887 {
13888 bool match = false;
13889
13890 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
13891 if (b->number == i)
13892 {
13893 match = true;
13894 function (b);
13895 break;
13896 }
13897 if (!match)
13898 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i);
13899 }
13900 }
13901 }
13902
13903 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in
13904 ARGS. */
13905
13906 static void
13907 map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args,
13908 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13909 {
13910 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
13911 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
13912
13913 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
13914
13915 while (!parser.finished ())
13916 {
13917 int num = parser.get_number ();
13918 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function);
13919 }
13920 }
13921
13922 /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the
13923 BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */
13924
13925 static struct bp_location *
13926 find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num)
13927 {
13928 struct breakpoint *b;
13929
13930 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13931 if (b->number == bp_num)
13932 {
13933 break;
13934 }
13935
13936 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
13937 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num);
13938
13939 if (loc_num == 0)
13940 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
13941
13942 int n = 0;
13943 for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
13944 if (++n == loc_num)
13945 return loc;
13946
13947 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
13948 }
13949
13950 /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */
13951 enum class extract_bp_kind
13952 {
13953 /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */
13954 bp,
13955
13956 /* Extracting a location number. */
13957 loc,
13958 };
13959
13960 /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND)
13961 from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which
13962 can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use
13963 '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed
13964 string. This always returns a positive integer. */
13965
13966 static int
13967 extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start,
13968 int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL)
13969 {
13970 const char *end = start;
13971 int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer);
13972 if (num < 0)
13973 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
13974 ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'")
13975 : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
13976 int (end - start), start);
13977 if (num == 0)
13978 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
13979 ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'")
13980 : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
13981 int (end - start), start);
13982
13983 if (end_out != NULL)
13984 *end_out = end;
13985 return num;
13986 }
13987
13988 /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in
13989 the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair
13990 representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements
13991 are always positive integers. */
13992
13993 static std::pair<int, int>
13994 extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind,
13995 const std::string &arg,
13996 std::string::size_type arg_offset)
13997 {
13998 std::pair<int, int> range;
13999 const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset];
14000 std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset);
14001 if (dash != std::string::npos)
14002 {
14003 /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */
14004 if (arg.length () == dash + 1)
14005 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14006 ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'")
14007 : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"),
14008 bp_loc);
14009
14010 const char *end;
14011 const char *start_first = bp_loc;
14012 const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1];
14013 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-');
14014 range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end);
14015
14016 if (range.first > range.second)
14017 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14018 ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'")
14019 : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"),
14020 int (end - start_first), start_first);
14021 }
14022 else
14023 {
14024 /* bp_loc is a single value. */
14025 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0');
14026 range.second = range.first;
14027 }
14028 return range;
14029 }
14030
14031 /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns
14032 the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in
14033 BP_LOC_RANGE.
14034
14035 ARG may be in any of the following forms:
14036
14037 x where 'x' is a breakpoint number.
14038 x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range.
14039 x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number.
14040 x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a
14041 location number range.
14042 */
14043
14044 static void
14045 extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg,
14046 std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range,
14047 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range)
14048 {
14049 std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.');
14050
14051 if (dot != std::string::npos)
14052 {
14053 /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */
14054
14055 if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0)
14056 error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ());
14057
14058 bp_num_range.first
14059 = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.');
14060 bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first;
14061
14062 bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc,
14063 arg, dot + 1);
14064 }
14065 else
14066 {
14067 /* Handle x and x-y cases. */
14068
14069 bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0);
14070 bp_loc_range.first = 0;
14071 bp_loc_range.second = 0;
14072 }
14073 }
14074
14075 /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE
14076 specifies whether to enable or disable. */
14077
14078 static void
14079 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable)
14080 {
14081 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num);
14082 if (loc != NULL)
14083 {
14084 if (loc->enabled != enable)
14085 {
14086 loc->enabled = enable;
14087 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14088 }
14089 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14090 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14091 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14092 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14093 }
14094 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14095
14096 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (loc->owner);
14097 }
14098
14099 /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the
14100 number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the
14101 (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to
14102 enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the
14103 location. */
14104
14105 static void
14106 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num,
14107 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range,
14108 bool enable)
14109 {
14110 for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++)
14111 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable);
14112 }
14113
14114 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14115 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14116 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14117
14118 void
14119 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14120 {
14121 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14122 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14123 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14124 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14125 return;
14126
14127 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14128
14129 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14130 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14131
14132 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14133 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14134 {
14135 struct bp_location *location;
14136
14137 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14138 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14139 }
14140
14141 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14142
14143 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14144 }
14145
14146 /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s)
14147 specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by
14148 extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable
14149 or disable the breakpoints/locations. */
14150
14151 static void
14152 enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable)
14153 {
14154 if (args == 0)
14155 {
14156 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14157
14158 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14159 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14160 {
14161 if (enable)
14162 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14163 else
14164 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14165 }
14166 }
14167 else
14168 {
14169 std::string num = extract_arg (&args);
14170
14171 while (!num.empty ())
14172 {
14173 std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range;
14174
14175 extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range);
14176
14177 if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second
14178 && bp_loc_range.first == 0)
14179 {
14180 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */
14181 map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range,
14182 enable
14183 ? enable_breakpoint
14184 : disable_breakpoint);
14185 }
14186 else
14187 {
14188 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or
14189 'x.y-z'. */
14190 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range
14191 (bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable);
14192 }
14193 num = extract_arg (&args);
14194 }
14195 }
14196 }
14197
14198 /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations
14199 (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in
14200 stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in
14201 extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14202
14203 static void
14204 disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14205 {
14206 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false);
14207 }
14208
14209 static void
14210 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14211 int count)
14212 {
14213 int target_resources_ok;
14214
14215 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14216 {
14217 int i;
14218 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14219 target_resources_ok =
14220 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14221 i + 1, 0);
14222 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14223 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14224 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14225 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14226 }
14227
14228 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14229 {
14230 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14231 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14232
14233 try
14234 {
14235 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14236
14237 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14238 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14239 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14240 }
14241 catch (const gdb_exception &e)
14242 {
14243 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14244 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14245 bpt->number);
14246 return;
14247 }
14248 }
14249
14250 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14251
14252 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14253 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14254
14255 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14256 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14257 {
14258 struct bp_location *location;
14259
14260 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14261 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14262 }
14263
14264 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14265 bpt->enable_count = count;
14266 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14267
14268 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14269 }
14270
14271
14272 void
14273 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14274 {
14275 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14276 }
14277
14278 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or
14279 all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to
14280 be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the
14281 forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14282
14283 static void
14284 enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14285 {
14286 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true);
14287 }
14288
14289 static void
14290 enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14291 {
14292 map_breakpoint_numbers
14293 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14294 {
14295 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14296 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14297 {
14298 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1);
14299 });
14300 });
14301 }
14302
14303 static void
14304 enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14305 {
14306 int count;
14307
14308 if (args == NULL)
14309 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
14310
14311 count = get_number (&args);
14312
14313 map_breakpoint_numbers
14314 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14315 {
14316 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14317 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14318 {
14319 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count);
14320 });
14321 });
14322 }
14323
14324 static void
14325 enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14326 {
14327 map_breakpoint_numbers
14328 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14329 {
14330 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14331 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14332 {
14333 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1);
14334 });
14335 });
14336 }
14337 \f
14338 static void
14339 set_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14340 {
14341 }
14342
14343 static void
14344 show_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14345 {
14346 }
14347
14348 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14349 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14350 GDB itself. */
14351
14352 static void
14353 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
14354 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
14355 const bfd_byte *data)
14356 {
14357 struct breakpoint *bp;
14358
14359 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
14360 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
14361 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
14362 {
14363 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
14364
14365 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val != nullptr)
14366 {
14367 struct bp_location *loc;
14368
14369 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14370 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14371 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
14372 && addr + len > loc->address)
14373 {
14374 wp->val = NULL;
14375 wp->val_valid = false;
14376 }
14377 }
14378 }
14379 }
14380
14381 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14382
14383 void
14384 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14385 const address_space *aspace,
14386 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
14387 {
14388 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
14389 struct symtab_and_line sal;
14390 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
14391
14392 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
14393 {
14394 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
14395 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
14396 }
14397
14398 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
14399 sal.pc = pc;
14400 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
14401 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
14402 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
14403
14404 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
14405 }
14406
14407 /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
14408
14409 int
14410 insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
14411 {
14412 struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache ();
14413 std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs;
14414
14415 next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache);
14416
14417 if (!next_pcs.empty ())
14418 {
14419 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
14420 const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame);
14421
14422 for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs)
14423 insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc);
14424
14425 return 1;
14426 }
14427 else
14428 return 0;
14429 }
14430
14431 /* See breakpoint.h. */
14432
14433 int
14434 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
14435 const address_space *aspace,
14436 CORE_ADDR pc)
14437 {
14438 struct bp_location *loc;
14439
14440 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14441 if (loc->inserted
14442 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
14443 return 1;
14444
14445 return 0;
14446 }
14447
14448 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
14449 PC. */
14450
14451 int
14452 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
14453 CORE_ADDR pc)
14454 {
14455 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14456
14457 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14458 {
14459 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
14460 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
14461 return 1;
14462 }
14463 return 0;
14464 }
14465
14466 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14467
14468 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14469 static void
14470 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
14471 {
14472 tracepoint_count = num;
14473 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
14474 }
14475
14476 static void
14477 trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14478 {
14479 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14480 current_language);
14481 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_event_location
14482 (location.get (), true /* is_tracepoint */);
14483
14484 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14485 location.get (),
14486 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14487 0 /* tempflag */,
14488 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14489 0 /* Ignore count */,
14490 pending_break_support,
14491 ops,
14492 from_tty,
14493 1 /* enabled */,
14494 0 /* internal */, 0);
14495 }
14496
14497 static void
14498 ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14499 {
14500 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14501 current_language);
14502 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14503 location.get (),
14504 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14505 0 /* tempflag */,
14506 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14507 0 /* Ignore count */,
14508 pending_break_support,
14509 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14510 from_tty,
14511 1 /* enabled */,
14512 0 /* internal */, 0);
14513 }
14514
14515 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
14516
14517 static void
14518 strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14519 {
14520 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14521 event_location_up location;
14522
14523 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
14524 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
14525 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
14526 {
14527 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
14528 location = new_linespec_location (&arg, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
14529 }
14530 else
14531 {
14532 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14533 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
14534 }
14535
14536 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14537 location.get (),
14538 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14539 0 /* tempflag */,
14540 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14541 0 /* Ignore count */,
14542 pending_break_support,
14543 ops,
14544 from_tty,
14545 1 /* enabled */,
14546 0 /* internal */, 0);
14547 }
14548
14549 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
14550 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
14551
14552 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
14553 static int next_cmd;
14554
14555 static char *
14556 read_uploaded_action (void)
14557 {
14558 char *rslt = nullptr;
14559
14560 if (next_cmd < this_utp->cmd_strings.size ())
14561 {
14562 rslt = this_utp->cmd_strings[next_cmd].get ();
14563 next_cmd++;
14564 }
14565
14566 return rslt;
14567 }
14568
14569 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
14570 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
14571 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
14572 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
14573 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
14574
14575 struct tracepoint *
14576 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
14577 {
14578 const char *addr_str;
14579 char small_buf[100];
14580 struct tracepoint *tp;
14581
14582 if (utp->at_string)
14583 addr_str = utp->at_string.get ();
14584 else
14585 {
14586 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
14587 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
14588 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
14589 user. */
14590 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
14591 "source location, using raw address"),
14592 utp->number);
14593 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
14594 addr_str = small_buf;
14595 }
14596
14597 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
14598 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
14599 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
14600 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
14601 utp->number);
14602
14603 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str,
14604 current_language);
14605 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14606 location.get (),
14607 utp->cond_string.get (), -1, addr_str,
14608 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
14609 0 /* tempflag */,
14610 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
14611 0 /* Ignore count */,
14612 pending_break_support,
14613 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14614 0 /* from_tty */,
14615 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
14616 0 /* internal */,
14617 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
14618 return NULL;
14619
14620 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
14621 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
14622 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
14623
14624 if (utp->pass > 0)
14625 {
14626 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
14627 tp->number);
14628
14629 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
14630 }
14631
14632 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
14633 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
14634 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
14635 function. */
14636 if (!utp->cmd_strings.empty ())
14637 {
14638 counted_command_line cmd_list;
14639
14640 this_utp = utp;
14641 next_cmd = 0;
14642
14643 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL);
14644
14645 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list));
14646 }
14647 else if (!utp->actions.empty ()
14648 || !utp->step_actions.empty ())
14649 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
14650 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
14651 utp->number);
14652
14653 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
14654 tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count;
14655 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
14656
14657 return tp;
14658 }
14659
14660 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
14661 omitted. */
14662
14663 static void
14664 info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14665 {
14666 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14667 int num_printed;
14668
14669 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_tracepoint);
14670
14671 if (num_printed == 0)
14672 {
14673 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14674 uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n");
14675 else
14676 uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
14677 }
14678
14679 default_collect_info ();
14680 }
14681
14682 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
14683 Not supported by all targets. */
14684 static void
14685 enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14686 {
14687 enable_command (args, from_tty);
14688 }
14689
14690 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
14691 Not supported by all targets. */
14692 static void
14693 disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14694 {
14695 disable_command (args, from_tty);
14696 }
14697
14698 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
14699 static void
14700 delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14701 {
14702 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14703
14704 dont_repeat ();
14705
14706 if (arg == 0)
14707 {
14708 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14709
14710 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
14711 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
14712 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
14713 argument. */
14714 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14715 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14716 {
14717 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14718 break;
14719 }
14720
14721 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14722 if (!from_tty
14723 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
14724 {
14725 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14726 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14727 delete_breakpoint (b);
14728 }
14729 }
14730 else
14731 map_breakpoint_numbers
14732 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
14733 {
14734 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
14735 });
14736 }
14737
14738 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
14739
14740 static void
14741 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
14742 {
14743 tp->pass_count = count;
14744 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (tp);
14745 if (from_tty)
14746 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
14747 tp->number, count);
14748 }
14749
14750 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
14751
14752 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
14753 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
14754 Also accepts special argument "all". */
14755
14756 static void
14757 trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14758 {
14759 struct tracepoint *t1;
14760 ULONGEST count;
14761
14762 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
14763 error (_("passcount command requires an "
14764 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
14765
14766 count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
14767
14768 args = skip_spaces (args);
14769 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
14770 {
14771 struct breakpoint *b;
14772
14773 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
14774 if (*args)
14775 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
14776
14777 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14778 {
14779 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14780 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14781 }
14782 }
14783 else if (*args == '\0')
14784 {
14785 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
14786 if (t1)
14787 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14788 }
14789 else
14790 {
14791 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14792 while (!parser.finished ())
14793 {
14794 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
14795 if (t1)
14796 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14797 }
14798 }
14799 }
14800
14801 struct tracepoint *
14802 get_tracepoint (int num)
14803 {
14804 struct breakpoint *t;
14805
14806 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
14807 if (t->number == num)
14808 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14809
14810 return NULL;
14811 }
14812
14813 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
14814 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
14815 reconnecting). */
14816
14817 struct tracepoint *
14818 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
14819 {
14820 struct breakpoint *b;
14821
14822 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14823 {
14824 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14825
14826 if (t->number_on_target == num)
14827 return t;
14828 }
14829
14830 return NULL;
14831 }
14832
14833 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
14834 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
14835 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
14836 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
14837
14838 struct tracepoint *
14839 get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg,
14840 number_or_range_parser *parser)
14841 {
14842 struct breakpoint *t;
14843 int tpnum;
14844 const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
14845
14846 if (parser != NULL)
14847 {
14848 gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
14849 tpnum = parser->get_number ();
14850 }
14851 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
14852 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
14853 else
14854 tpnum = get_number (arg);
14855
14856 if (tpnum <= 0)
14857 {
14858 if (instring && *instring)
14859 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
14860 instring);
14861 else
14862 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
14863 return NULL;
14864 }
14865
14866 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
14867 if (t->number == tpnum)
14868 {
14869 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14870 }
14871
14872 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
14873 return NULL;
14874 }
14875
14876 void
14877 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
14878 {
14879 if (b->thread != -1)
14880 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
14881
14882 if (b->task != 0)
14883 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
14884
14885 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
14886 }
14887
14888 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
14889 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
14890 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
14891 true. */
14892
14893 static void
14894 save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty,
14895 bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
14896 {
14897 struct breakpoint *tp;
14898 int any = 0;
14899 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
14900
14901 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
14902 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
14903
14904 /* See if we have anything to save. */
14905 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
14906 {
14907 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
14908 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
14909 continue;
14910
14911 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
14912 if (filter && !filter (tp))
14913 continue;
14914
14915 any = 1;
14916
14917 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
14918 {
14919 extra_trace_bits = 1;
14920
14921 /* We can stop searching. */
14922 break;
14923 }
14924 }
14925
14926 if (!any)
14927 {
14928 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
14929 return;
14930 }
14931
14932 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename));
14933
14934 stdio_file fp;
14935
14936 if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w"))
14937 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
14938 expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno));
14939
14940 if (extra_trace_bits)
14941 save_trace_state_variables (&fp);
14942
14943 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
14944 {
14945 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
14946 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
14947 continue;
14948
14949 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
14950 if (filter && !filter (tp))
14951 continue;
14952
14953 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, &fp);
14954
14955 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
14956 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
14957 instead. */
14958
14959 if (tp->cond_string)
14960 fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
14961
14962 if (tp->ignore_count)
14963 fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
14964
14965 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
14966 {
14967 fp.puts (" commands\n");
14968
14969 current_uiout->redirect (&fp);
14970 try
14971 {
14972 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands.get (), 2);
14973 }
14974 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
14975 {
14976 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
14977 throw;
14978 }
14979
14980 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
14981 fp.puts (" end\n");
14982 }
14983
14984 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
14985 fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n");
14986
14987 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
14988 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
14989 special, and not user visible. */
14990 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
14991 {
14992 struct bp_location *loc;
14993 int n = 1;
14994
14995 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
14996 if (!loc->enabled)
14997 fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
14998 }
14999 }
15000
15001 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15002 fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15003
15004 if (from_tty)
15005 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ());
15006 }
15007
15008 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15009
15010 static void
15011 save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15012 {
15013 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15014 }
15015
15016 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15017
15018 static void
15019 save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15020 {
15021 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15022 }
15023
15024 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15025
15026 std::vector<breakpoint *>
15027 all_tracepoints (void)
15028 {
15029 std::vector<breakpoint *> tp_vec;
15030 struct breakpoint *tp;
15031
15032 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15033 {
15034 tp_vec.push_back (tp);
15035 }
15036
15037 return tp_vec;
15038 }
15039
15040 \f
15041 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15042 locations used by several commands. */
15043
15044 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15045 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15046 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15047 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15048 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15049 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15050 \n\
15051 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15052 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15053 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15054 \n\
15055 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15056 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15057 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15058 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15059 -function fact -label the_top\".\n\
15060 \n\
15061 By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\
15062 functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\
15063 classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\
15064 \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\
15065 \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\
15066 specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead."
15067
15068 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15069 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15070 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15071 command. */
15072
15073 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15074 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15075 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15076 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15077 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15078 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15079 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15080 below.\n\
15081 \n\
15082 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15083 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15084 \n\
15085 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15086 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15087 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
15088 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15089 conditions are different.\n\
15090 \n\
15091 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15092
15093 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15094 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15095
15096 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15097 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15098
15099 void
15100 add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring,
15101 cmd_const_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15102 completer_ftype *completer,
15103 void *user_data_catch,
15104 void *user_data_tcatch)
15105 {
15106 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15107
15108 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15109 &catch_cmdlist);
15110 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15111 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15112 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15113
15114 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15115 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15116 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15117 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15118 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15119 }
15120
15121 struct breakpoint *
15122 iterate_over_breakpoints (gdb::function_view<bool (breakpoint *)> callback)
15123 {
15124 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15125
15126 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15127 {
15128 if (callback (b))
15129 return b;
15130 }
15131
15132 return NULL;
15133 }
15134
15135 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15136 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15137
15138 static int
15139 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15140 {
15141 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15142 non-inline function. */
15143 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15144 return 1;
15145
15146 return 0;
15147 }
15148
15149 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15150 have been inlined. */
15151
15152 int
15153 pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15154 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15155 {
15156 struct breakpoint *b;
15157 struct bp_location *bl;
15158
15159 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
15160 {
15161 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15162 continue;
15163
15164 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
15165 {
15166 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15167 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15168 return 1;
15169 }
15170 }
15171
15172 return 0;
15173 }
15174
15175 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15176
15177 void
15178 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15179 {
15180 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
15181
15182 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
15183 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15184 loc->symtab = NULL;
15185 }
15186
15187 void
15188 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15189 {
15190 static int initialized = 0;
15191
15192 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15193
15194 if (initialized)
15195 return;
15196 initialized = 1;
15197
15198 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15199 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15200 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15201 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15202 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15203 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15204 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
15205 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
15206 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
15207 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
15208 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
15209 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
15210
15211 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15212 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15213 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15214 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15215 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15216 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15217 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15218 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15219
15220 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15221 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
15222 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15223 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
15224 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
15225 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
15226 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
15227 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
15228 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
15229 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
15230
15231 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15232 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
15233 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15234 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
15235 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
15236 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
15237 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
15238
15239 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15240 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15241 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15242 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
15243 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
15244 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
15245 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
15246
15247 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15248 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15249 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15250 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
15251 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
15252 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15253 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
15254
15255 /* Watchpoints. */
15256 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15257 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15258 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
15259 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
15260 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
15261 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
15262 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
15263 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
15264 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
15265 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
15266 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
15267 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
15268 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
15269
15270 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15271 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15272 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15273 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
15274 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
15275 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
15276 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
15277 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
15278 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
15279 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
15280 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
15281
15282 /* Tracepoints. */
15283 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15284 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15285 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
15286 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
15287 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
15288 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
15289 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
15290 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
15291 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
15292 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
15293
15294 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15295 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15296 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15297 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15298 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
15299
15300 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15301 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15302 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15303 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
15304 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
15305 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
15306
15307 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15308 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
15309 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15310 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
15311 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
15312 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
15313 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
15314 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
15315 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
15316 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
15317
15318 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15319 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
15320 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15321 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
15322 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
15323 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
15324 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
15325 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
15326 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
15327 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
15328
15329 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15330 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
15331 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15332 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
15333 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
15334 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
15335 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
15336 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
15337 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
15338 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
15339
15340 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15341 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
15342 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15343 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
15344 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
15345 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
15346 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
15347 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
15348 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
15349 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
15350 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
15351
15352 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
15353 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15354 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
15355 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15356 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15357 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15358 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
15359 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
15360 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
15361 }
15362
15363 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
15364
15365 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
15366
15367 /* See breakpoint.h. */
15368
15369 cmd_list_element *commands_cmd_element = nullptr;
15370
15371 void _initialize_breakpoint ();
15372 void
15373 _initialize_breakpoint ()
15374 {
15375 struct cmd_list_element *c;
15376
15377 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15378
15379 gdb::observers::solib_unloaded.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
15380 gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
15381 gdb::observers::memory_changed.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
15382
15383 breakpoint_chain = 0;
15384 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15385 before a breakpoint is set. */
15386 breakpoint_count = 0;
15387
15388 tracepoint_count = 0;
15389
15390 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
15391 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15392 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15393
15394 commands_cmd_element = add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint,
15395 commands_command, _("\
15396 Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\
15397 Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15398 A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\
15399 (e.g. `5-7').\n\
15400 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15401 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15402 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15403 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
15404 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
15405
15406 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
15407 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
15408 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
15409 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
15410 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
15411
15412 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
15413 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
15414 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15415 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
15416 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
15417 \n"
15418 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
15419 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15420
15421 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
15422 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15423 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
15424 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
15425 \n"
15426 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
15427 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15428
15429 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
15430 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15431 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15432 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
15433 \n"
15434 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
15435 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15436
15437 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15438 Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15439 Usage: enable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15440 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15441 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15442 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15443 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
15444 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15445
15446 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15447
15448 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15449 Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15450 Usage: enable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15451 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15452 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15453 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\"."),
15454 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
15455
15456 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15457 Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\
15458 Usage: enable breakpoints once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15459 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15460 &enablebreaklist);
15461
15462 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15463 Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\
15464 Usage: enable breakpoints delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15465 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15466 &enablebreaklist);
15467
15468 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15469 Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\
15470 Usage: enable breakpoints count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15471 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15472 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15473 &enablebreaklist);
15474
15475 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15476 Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\
15477 Usage: enable delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15478 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15479 &enablelist);
15480
15481 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15482 Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\
15483 Usage: enable once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15484 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15485 &enablelist);
15486
15487 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15488 Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\
15489 Usage: enable count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15490 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15491 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15492 &enablelist);
15493
15494 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15495 Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15496 Usage: disable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15497 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15498 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15499 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
15500 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15501 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15502 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15503
15504 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
15505 Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15506 Usage: disable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15507 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15508 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15509 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
15510 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
15511 &disablelist);
15512
15513 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15514 Delete all or some breakpoints.\n\
15515 Usage: delete [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15516 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15517 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15518 \n\
15519 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects."),
15520 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
15521 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15522 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15523
15524 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
15525 Delete all or some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15526 Usage: delete breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15527 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15528 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15529 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
15530 &deletelist);
15531
15532 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
15533 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
15534 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
15535 \n\
15536 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
15537 is executing in.\n"
15538 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
15539 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
15540 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
15541
15542 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
15543 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
15544 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
15545 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15546
15547 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
15548 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
15549 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
15550 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
15551
15552 if (dbx_commands)
15553 {
15554 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
15555 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
15556 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
15557 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
15558 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
15559 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
15560 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
15561 add_com ("status", class_info, info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15562 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15563 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15564 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15565 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15566 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15567 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15568 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15569 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15570 \n\
15571 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15572 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15573 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15574 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15575 breakpoint set."));
15576 }
15577
15578 add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15579 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
15580 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15581 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15582 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15583 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15584 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15585 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15586 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15587 \n\
15588 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15589 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15590 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15591 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15592 breakpoint set."));
15593
15594 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
15595
15596 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
15597 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15598 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15599 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15600 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15601 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
15602 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
15603 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
15604 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
15605 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15606 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15607 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15608 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15609 \n\
15610 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15611 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15612 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15613 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15614 breakpoint set."),
15615 &maintenanceinfolist);
15616
15617 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
15618 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
15619 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
15620 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15621
15622 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
15623 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
15624 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
15625 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15626
15627 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
15628 catch_fork_command_1,
15629 NULL,
15630 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
15631 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
15632 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
15633 catch_fork_command_1,
15634 NULL,
15635 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
15636 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
15637 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
15638 catch_exec_command_1,
15639 NULL,
15640 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15641 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15642 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
15643 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
15644 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15645 catch_load_command_1,
15646 NULL,
15647 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15648 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15649 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
15650 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
15651 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15652 catch_unload_command_1,
15653 NULL,
15654 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15655 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15656
15657 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
15658 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15659 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15660 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15661 an expression changes.\n\
15662 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15663 the memory to which it refers."));
15664 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15665
15666 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
15667 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15668 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15669 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15670 an expression is read.\n\
15671 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15672 the memory to which it refers."));
15673 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15674
15675 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
15676 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15677 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15678 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15679 an expression is either read or written.\n\
15680 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15681 the memory to which it refers."));
15682 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15683
15684 add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\
15685 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
15686
15687 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
15688 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
15689 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
15690 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
15691 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15692 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15693 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
15694 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
15695 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
15696 hardware.)"),
15697 NULL,
15698 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
15699 &setlist, &showlist);
15700
15701 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
15702
15703 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
15704
15705 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
15706 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15707 \n"
15708 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
15709 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15710 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15711
15712 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
15713 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15714 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15715 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15716
15717 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
15718 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15719 \n"
15720 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
15721 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15722 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15723
15724 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
15725 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
15726 \n\
15727 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
15728 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
15729 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
15730 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
15731 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
15732 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
15733 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
15734 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
15735 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
15736 \n\
15737 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15738 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
15739 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15740 conditions are different.\n\
15741 \n\
15742 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
15743 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15744 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15745
15746 add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\
15747 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
15748 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
15749 last tracepoint set."));
15750
15751 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
15752
15753 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
15754 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
15755 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15756 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
15757 &deletelist);
15758 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
15759
15760 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
15761 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
15762 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15763 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
15764 &disablelist);
15765 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
15766
15767 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
15768 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
15769 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15770 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
15771 &enablelist);
15772 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
15773
15774 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
15775 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
15776 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
15777 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
15778 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
15779
15780 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint,
15781 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
15782 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
15783 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15784
15785 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
15786 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
15787 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
15788 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
15789 session to restore them."),
15790 &save_cmdlist);
15791 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15792
15793 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
15794 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
15795 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
15796 &save_cmdlist);
15797 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15798
15799 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
15800 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
15801
15802 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
15803 Breakpoint specific settings.\n\
15804 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15805 pending breakpoint behavior."),
15806 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
15807 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
15808 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
15809 Breakpoint specific settings.\n\
15810 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15811 pending breakpoint behavior."),
15812 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
15813 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
15814
15815 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
15816 &pending_break_support, _("\
15817 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15818 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15819 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
15820 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
15821 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
15822 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
15823 NULL,
15824 show_pending_break_support,
15825 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15826 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15827
15828 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
15829
15830 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
15831 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
15832 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15833 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15834 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
15835 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
15836 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
15837 NULL,
15838 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
15839 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15840 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15841
15842 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
15843 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
15844 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15845 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15846 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
15847 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
15848 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
15849 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
15850 when execution stops."),
15851 NULL,
15852 &show_always_inserted_mode,
15853 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15854 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15855
15856 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
15857 condition_evaluation_enums,
15858 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
15859 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15860 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15861 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
15862 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
15863 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
15864 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
15865 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
15866 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
15867 be set to \"gdb\""),
15868 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
15869 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
15870 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15871 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15872
15873 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
15874 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
15875 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
15876 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
15877 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
15878 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
15879 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
15880 or the start of the range\n\
15881 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
15882 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
15883 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
15884 \n\
15885 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
15886 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
15887 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
15888
15889 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
15890 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
15891 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
15892 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
15893 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
15894 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15895
15896 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
15897 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
15898 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
15899 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
15900 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
15901 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
15902 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
15903 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
15904 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
15905 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
15906 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
15907 &setlist, &showlist);
15908
15909 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
15910 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
15911 &dprintf_function, _("\
15912 Set the function to use for dynamic printf."), _("\
15913 Show the function to use for dynamic printf."), NULL,
15914 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
15915 &setlist, &showlist);
15916
15917 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
15918 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
15919 &dprintf_channel, _("\
15920 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf."), _("\
15921 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf."), NULL,
15922 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
15923 &setlist, &showlist);
15924
15925 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
15926 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
15927 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
15928 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
15929 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
15930 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
15931 NULL,
15932 NULL,
15933 &setlist, &showlist);
15934
15935 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
15936 Target agent only formatted printing, like the C \"printf\" function.\n\
15937 Usage: agent-printf \"format string\", ARG1, ARG2, ARG3, ..., ARGN\n\
15938 This supports most C printf format specifications, like %s, %d, etc.\n\
15939 This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
15940
15941 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = true;
15942
15943 gdb::observers::about_to_proceed.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
15944 gdb::observers::thread_exit.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints);
15945 }